DS2155GN [MAXIM]
T1/E1/J1 Single-Chip Transceiver;型号: | DS2155GN |
厂家: | MAXIM INTEGRATED PRODUCTS |
描述: | T1/E1/J1 Single-Chip Transceiver 电信 电信集成电路 |
文件: | 总238页 (文件大小:2001K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
DS2155
T1/E1/J1 Single-Chip Transceiver
www.maxim-ic.com
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
FEATURES
The DS2155 is a software-selectable T1, E1, or J1
single-chip transceiver (SCT) for short-haul and
long-haul applications. The DS2155 is composed of a
line interface unit (LIU), framer, HDLC controllers,
and a TDM backplane interface, and is controlled by
an 8-bit parallel port configured for Intel or Motorola
bus operations. The DS2155 is pin and software
compatible with the DS2156.
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Complete T1/DS1/ISDN-PRI/J1 Transceiver
Functionality
Complete E1 (CEPT) PCM-30/ISDN-PRI
Transceiver Functionality
Long-Haul and Short-Haul Line Interface for
Clock/Data Recovery and Waveshaping
CMI Coder/Decoder for Optical I/F
Crystal-Less Jitter Attenuator
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Fully Independent Transmit and Receive
Functionality
The LIU is composed of transmit and receive
interfaces and a jitter attenuator. The transmit
interface is responsible for generating the necessary
waveshapes for driving the network and providing
the correct source impedance depending on the type
of media used. T1 waveform generation includes
DSX-1 line buildouts as well as CSU line buildouts
of -7.5dB, -15dB, and -22.5dB. E1 waveform
generation includes G.703 waveshapes for both 75Ω
coax and 120Ω twisted cables. The receive interface
provides network termination and recovers clock and
data from the network.
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Dual HDLC Controllers
Programmable BERT Generator and Detector
Internal Software-Selectable Receive and
Transmit-Side Termination Resistors for
75ꢀ/100ꢀ/120ꢀ T1 and E1 Interfaces
Dual Two-Frame Elastic-Store Slip Buffers that
Connect to Asynchronous Backplanes Up to
16.384MHz
16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, or
2.048MHz Clock Output Synthesized to
Recovered Network Clock
ꢀ
ꢀ
Features continued in Section 3.
APPLICATIONS
T1/E1/J1 Line Cards
Switches and Routers
Add-Drop Multiplexers
ORDERING INFORMATION
PART
TEMP RANGE PIN-PACKAGE
DS2155L
0°C to +70°C
0°C to +70°C
-40°C to +85°C 100 LQFP
-40°C to +85°C 100 LQFP
0°C to +70°C
0°C to +70°C
-40°C to +85°C 100 CSBGA
-40°C to +85°C 100 CSBGA
100 LQFP
100 LQFP
DS2155L+
DS2155LN
DS2155LN+
DS2155G
DS2155G+
DS2155GN
DS2155GN
DS2155
T1/E1/J1
SCT
T1/E1/J1
NETWORK
BACKPLANE
100 CSBGA
100 CSBGA
TDM
+ Denotes a lead-free/RoHS-compliant package.
Note: Some revisions of this device may incorporate deviations from published specifications known as errata. Multiple revisions of any device
may be simultaneously available through various sales channels. For information about device errata, click here: www.maxim-ic.com/errata.
1 of 238
REV: 080607
DS2155
1. TABLE OF CONTENTS
1.
TABLE OF CONTENTS............................................................................................................................2
1.1 TABLE OF FIGURES ........................................................................................................................................6
1.2 TABLE OF TABLES..........................................................................................................................................7
2.
3.
DATA SHEET REVISION HISTORY .....................................................................................................8
MAIN FEATURES....................................................................................................................................10
3.1 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION .........................................................................................................................13
3.2 BLOCK DIAGRAM.........................................................................................................................................15
4.
PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION ...........................................................................................................19
4.1 TRANSMIT SIDE ...........................................................................................................................................19
4.2 RECEIVE SIDE ..............................................................................................................................................21
4.3 PARALLEL CONTROL PORT PINS .................................................................................................................24
4.4 EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS......................................................................................................25
4.5 USER OUTPUT PORT PINS ............................................................................................................................26
4.6 JTAG TEST ACCESS PORT PINS...................................................................................................................27
4.7 LINE INTERFACE PINS..................................................................................................................................28
4.8 SUPPLY PINS ................................................................................................................................................29
4.9 L AND G PACKAGE PINOUT.........................................................................................................................30
4.10
10MM CSBGA PIN CONFIGURATION ......................................................................................................32
5.
6.
PARALLEL PORT ...................................................................................................................................33
5.1 REGISTER MAP ............................................................................................................................................33
PROGRAMMING MODEL.....................................................................................................................39
6.1 POWER-UP SEQUENCE.................................................................................................................................40
6.1.1
Master Mode Register.........................................................................................................................40
6.2 INTERRUPT HANDLING ................................................................................................................................41
6.3 STATUS REGISTERS......................................................................................................................................41
6.4 INFORMATION REGISTERS ...........................................................................................................................42
6.5 INTERRUPT INFORMATION REGISTERS ........................................................................................................42
7.
8.
9.
SPECIAL PER-CHANNEL REGISTER OPERATION.......................................................................43
CLOCK MAP ............................................................................................................................................45
T1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS............................................46
9.1 T1 CONTROL REGISTERS .............................................................................................................................46
9.2 T1 TRANSMIT TRANSPARENCY ...................................................................................................................51
9.3 AIS-CI AND RAI-CI GENERATION AND DETECTION ..................................................................................51
9.4 T1 RECEIVE-SIDE DIGITAL-MILLIWATT CODE GENERATION.....................................................................52
10.
E1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS............................................55
10.1
E1 CONTROL REGISTERS.........................................................................................................................55
AUTOMATIC ALARM GENERATION .........................................................................................................59
E1 INFORMATION REGISTERS..................................................................................................................60
10.2
10.3
11.
11.1
COMMON CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS ..........................................................................62
T1/E1 STATUS REGISTERS ......................................................................................................................63
2 of 238
DS2155
12.
13.
I/O PIN CONFIGURATION OPTIONS.................................................................................................69
LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION ..........................................................................................................71
PER-CHANNEL LOOPBACK ......................................................................................................................73
ERROR COUNT REGISTERS ...............................................................................................................75
LINE-CODE VIOLATION COUNT REGISTER (LCVCR).............................................................................76
13.1
14.
14.1
14.1.1 T1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................76
14.1.2 E1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................76
14.2
PATH CODE VIOLATION COUNT REGISTER (PCVCR) ............................................................................78
14.2.1 T1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................78
14.2.2 E1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................78
14.3
FRAMES OUT-OF-SYNC COUNT REGISTER (FOSCR)..............................................................................79
14.3.1 T1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................79
14.3.2 E1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................79
14.4
E-BIT COUNTER (EBCR).........................................................................................................................80
15.
DS0 MONITORING FUNCTION ...........................................................................................................81
16.
SIGNALING OPERATION .....................................................................................................................83
16.1
RECEIVE SIGNALING ...............................................................................................................................83
16.1.1 Processor-Based Signaling.................................................................................................................83
16.1.2 Hardware-Based Receive Signaling ...................................................................................................84
16.2
TRANSMIT SIGNALING.............................................................................................................................89
16.2.1 Processor-Based Mode.......................................................................................................................89
16.2.2 Software Signaling Insertion-Enable Registers, E1 CAS Mode..........................................................93
16.2.3 Software Signaling Insertion-Enable Registers, T1 Mode..................................................................95
16.2.4 Hardware-Based Mode.......................................................................................................................95
17.
PER-CHANNEL IDLE CODE GENERATION ....................................................................................96
17.1
IDLE-CODE PROGRAMMING EXAMPLES..................................................................................................97
18.
CHANNEL BLOCKING REGISTERS ................................................................................................101
19.
ELASTIC STORES OPERATION........................................................................................................104
19.1
RECEIVE SIDE........................................................................................................................................107
19.1.1 T1 Mode............................................................................................................................................107
19.1.2 E1 Mode............................................................................................................................................107
19.2
TRANSMIT SIDE .....................................................................................................................................107
19.2.1 T1 Mode............................................................................................................................................108
19.2.2 E1 Mode............................................................................................................................................108
19.3
19.4
ELASTIC STORES INITIALIZATION .........................................................................................................108
MINIMUM DELAY MODE .......................................................................................................................108
20.
G.706 INTERMEDIATE CRC-4 UPDATING (E1 MODE ONLY)...................................................109
21.
T1 BIT-ORIENTED CODE (BOC) CONTROLLER..........................................................................110
21.1
TRANSMIT BOC.....................................................................................................................................110
Transmit a BOC ..............................................................................................................................................110
21.2
RECEIVE BOC .......................................................................................................................................110
Receive a BOC.................................................................................................................................................110
22.
ADDITIONAL (SA) AND INTERNATIONAL (SI) BIT OPERATION (E1 ONLY) ......................113
3 of 238
DS2155
22.1
22.2
22.3
METHOD 1: HARDWARE SCHEME .........................................................................................................113
METHOD 2: INTERNAL REGISTER SCHEME BASED ON DOUBLE-FRAME ..............................................113
METHOD 3: INTERNAL REGISTER SCHEME BASED ON CRC4 MULTIFRAME........................................116
23.
HDLC CONTROLLERS........................................................................................................................126
23.1
23.2
BASIC OPERATION DETAILS..................................................................................................................126
HDLC CONFIGURATION........................................................................................................................126
23.2.1 FIFO Control....................................................................................................................................130
23.3
HDLC MAPPING....................................................................................................................................131
23.3.1 Receive..............................................................................................................................................131
23.3.2 Transmit............................................................................................................................................133
23.3.3 FIFO Information .............................................................................................................................138
23.3.4 Receive Packet-Bytes Available........................................................................................................138
23.3.5 HDLC FIFOs ....................................................................................................................................139
23.4
23.5
RECEIVE HDLC CODE EXAMPLE..........................................................................................................140
LEGACY FDL SUPPORT (T1 MODE)......................................................................................................140
23.5.1 Overview ...........................................................................................................................................140
23.5.2 Receive Section .................................................................................................................................140
23.5.3 Transmit Section ...............................................................................................................................142
23.6
24.
24.1
24.2
D4/SLC-96 OPERATION ........................................................................................................................142
LINE INTERFACE UNIT (LIU) ...........................................................................................................143
LIU OPERATION ....................................................................................................................................143
RECEIVER ..............................................................................................................................................143
24.2.1 Receive Level Indicator and Threshold Interrupt.............................................................................144
24.2.2 Receive G.703 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode)...........................................................................144
24.2.3 Monitor Mode ...................................................................................................................................144
24.3
TRANSMITTER .......................................................................................................................................145
24.3.1 Transmit Short-Circuit Detector/Limiter..........................................................................................145
24.3.2 Transmit Open-Circuit Detector.......................................................................................................145
24.3.3 Transmit BPV Error Insertion ..........................................................................................................145
24.3.4 Transmit G.703 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode).........................................................................145
24.4
MCLK PRESCALER ...............................................................................................................................146
JITTER ATTENUATOR.............................................................................................................................146
CMI (CODE MARK INVERSION) OPTION...............................................................................................146
LIU CONTROL REGISTERS.....................................................................................................................147
RECOMMENDED CIRCUITS.....................................................................................................................156
COMPONENT SPECIFICATIONS...............................................................................................................158
24.5
24.6
24.7
24.8
24.9
25.
26.
26.1
PROGRAMMABLE IN-BAND LOOP CODE GENERATION AND DETECTION......................163
BERT FUNCTION..................................................................................................................................170
STATUS..................................................................................................................................................170
MAPPING ...............................................................................................................................................170
BERT REGISTER DESCRIPTIONS ...........................................................................................................172
BERT REPETITIVE PATTERN SET..........................................................................................................176
BERT BIT COUNTER .............................................................................................................................177
BERT ERROR COUNTER........................................................................................................................178
26.2
26.3
26.4
26.5
26.6
27.
27.1
PAYLOAD ERROR-INSERTION FUNCTION (T1 MODE ONLY)................................................180
NUMBER-OF-ERRORS REGISTERS..........................................................................................................182
27.1.1 Number-of-Errors Left Register........................................................................................................183
INTERLEAVED PCM BUS OPERATION (IBO)...............................................................................184
4 of 238
28.
DS2155
28.1
28.2
CHANNEL INTERLEAVE .........................................................................................................................184
FRAME INTERLEAVE..............................................................................................................................184
29.
EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS (ESIB) .......................................................................187
PROGRAMMABLE BACKPLANE CLOCK SYNTHESIZER ........................................................191
FRACTIONAL T1/E1 SUPPORT .........................................................................................................191
USER-PROGRAMMABLE OUTPUT PINS........................................................................................193
TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAMS .........................................................................................................194
JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN ARCHITECTURE AND TEST ACCESS PORT .................................199
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
34.1
DESCRIPTION .........................................................................................................................................199
INSTRUCTION REGISTER........................................................................................................................202
TEST REGISTERS....................................................................................................................................204
BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER.................................................................................................................204
BYPASS REGISTER.................................................................................................................................204
IDENTIFICATION REGISTER....................................................................................................................204
34.2
34.3
34.4
34.5
34.6
35.
FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS.................................................................................................208
35.1
35.2
T1 MODE ...............................................................................................................................................208
E1 MODE ...............................................................................................................................................213
36.
OPERATING PARAMETERS..............................................................................................................222
37.
AC TIMING PARAMETERS AND DIAGRAMS ...............................................................................224
37.1
MULTIPLEXED BUS AC CHARACTERISTICS ..........................................................................................224
NONMULTIPLEXED BUS AC CHARACTERISTICS ...................................................................................227
RECEIVE-SIDE AC CHARACTERISTICS..................................................................................................230
BACKPLANE CLOCK TIMING: AC CHARACTERISTICS .........................................................................233
TRANSMIT AC CHARACTERISTICS ........................................................................................................234
37.2
37.3
37.4
37.5
38.
PACKAGE INFORMATION ................................................................................................................237
38.1
38.2
100-PIN LQFP (56-G5002-000)............................................................................................................237
100-BALL CSBGA (56-G6008-001) .....................................................................................................238
5 of 238
DS2155
1.1 Table of Figures
Figure 3-1. Block Diagram........................................................................................................................................ 15
Figure 3-2. Receive and Transmit LIU...................................................................................................................... 16
Figure 3-3. Receive and Transmit Framer/HDLC..................................................................................................... 17
Figure 3-4. Backplane Interface ................................................................................................................................ 18
Figure 4-1. 10mm CSBGA Pin Configuration .......................................................................................................... 32
Figure 6-1. Programming Sequence .......................................................................................................................... 39
Figure 8-1. Clock Map............................................................................................................................................... 45
Figure 16-1. Simplified Diagram of Receive Signaling Path .................................................................................... 83
Figure 16-2. Simplified Diagram of Transmit Signaling Path................................................................................... 89
Figure 20-1. CRC-4 Recalculate Method ................................................................................................................ 109
Figure 24-1. Typical Monitor Application .............................................................................................................. 144
Figure 24-2. CMI Coding ........................................................................................................................................ 146
Figure 24-3. Software-Selected Termination, Metallic Protection.......................................................................... 156
Figure 24-4. Software-Selected Termination, Longitudinal Protection................................................................... 157
Figure 24-5. E1 Transmit Pulse Template............................................................................................................... 159
Figure 24-6. T1 Transmit Pulse Template............................................................................................................... 159
Figure 24-7. Jitter Tolerance.................................................................................................................................... 160
Figure 24-8. Jitter Tolerance (E1 Mode) ................................................................................................................. 160
Figure 24-9. Jitter Attenuation (T1 Mode) .............................................................................................................. 161
Figure 24-10. Jitter Attenuation (E1 Mode) ............................................................................................................ 161
Figure 24-11. Optional Crystal Connections........................................................................................................... 162
Figure 26-1. Simplified Diagram of BERT in Network Direction.......................................................................... 171
Figure 26-2. Simplified Diagram of BERT in Backplane Direction ....................................................................... 171
Figure 28-1. IBO Example ...................................................................................................................................... 186
Figure 29-1. ESIB Group of Four DS2155s ............................................................................................................ 187
Figure 33-1. T1 Transmit Flow Diagram ................................................................................................................ 194
Figure 33-2. E1 Transmit Flow Diagram ................................................................................................................ 195
Figure 34-1. JTAG Functional Block Diagram ....................................................................................................... 199
Figure 34-2. TAP Controller State Diagram............................................................................................................ 202
Figure 35-1. Receive-Side D4 Timing..................................................................................................................... 208
Figure 35-2. Receive-Side ESF Timing................................................................................................................... 208
Figure 35-3. Receive-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)................................................................... 209
Figure 35-4. Receive-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled).................................................. 209
Figure 35-5. Receive-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled).................................................. 210
Figure 35-6. Transmit-Side D4 Timing................................................................................................................... 210
Figure 35-7. Transmit-Side ESF Timing................................................................................................................. 211
Figure 35-8. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (with Elastic Store Disabled)......................................................... 211
Figure 35-9. Transmit-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)................................................ 212
Figure 35-10. Transmit-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled).............................................. 212
Figure 35-11. Receive-Side Timing ........................................................................................................................ 213
Figure 35-12. Receive-Side Boundary Timing (with Elastic Store Disabled)......................................................... 213
Figure 35-13. Receive-Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (Elastic Store Enabled) ........................ 214
Figure 35-14. Receive-Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (Elastic Store Enabled) ........................ 214
Figure 35-15. Receive IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing ............................................................................... 215
Figure 35-16. Receive IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing................................................................................... 216
Figure 35-17. G.802 Timing, E1 Mode Only .......................................................................................................... 217
Figure 35-18. Transmit-Side Timing....................................................................................................................... 217
Figure 35-19. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)............................................................... 218
Figure 35-20. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (Elastic Store Enabled)...................... 218
Figure 35-21. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (Elastic Store Enabled)....................... 219
Figure 35-22. Transmit IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing.............................................................................. 220
6 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-23. Transmit IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing................................................................................. 221
Figure 37-1. Intel Multiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 1).................................................................. 225
Figure 37-2. Intel Multiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 1)................................................................. 225
Figure 37-3. Motorola Multiplexed Bus Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 1) ................................................................... 226
Figure 37-4. Intel Nonmultiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 0) ........................................................... 228
Figure 37-5. Intel Nonmultiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 0) .......................................................... 228
Figure 37-6. Motorola Nonmultiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 0).................................................... 229
Figure 37-7. Motorola Nonmultiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 0)................................................... 229
Figure 37-8. Receive-Side Timing .......................................................................................................................... 231
Figure 37-9. Receive-Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled ...................................................................................... 232
Figure 37-10. Receive Line Interface Timing ......................................................................................................... 232
Figure 37-11 Receive Timing Delay RCLK to BPCLK......................................................................................... 233
Figure 37-12. Transmit-Side Timing....................................................................................................................... 235
Figure 37-13. Transmit-Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled................................................................................... 236
Figure 37-14. Transmit Line Interface Timing........................................................................................................ 236
1.2 Table of Tables
Table 4-A. Pin Description Sorted by Pin Number ................................................................................................... 30
Table 5-A. Register Map Sorted by Address............................................................................................................. 33
Table 9-A. T1 Alarm Criteria.................................................................................................................................... 54
Table 10-A. E1 Sync/Resync Criteria ....................................................................................................................... 56
Table 10-B. E1 Alarm Criteria .................................................................................................................................. 61
Table 14-A. T1 Line Code Violation Counting Options ........................................................................................... 76
Table 14-B. E1 Line-Code Violation Counting Options........................................................................................... 76
Table 14-C. T1 Path Code Violation Counting Arrangements.................................................................................. 78
Table 14-D. T1 Frames Out-of-Sync Counting Arrangements ................................................................................. 79
Table 16-A. Time Slot Numbering Schemes............................................................................................................. 90
Table 17-A. Idle-Code Array Address Mapping ....................................................................................................... 96
Table 17-B. GRIC and GTIC Functions.................................................................................................................... 98
Table 19-A. Elastic Store Delay After Initialization ............................................................................................... 108
Table 23-A. HDLC Controller Registers................................................................................................................. 127
Table 24-A. Component List (Software-Selected Termination, Metallic Protection)............................................. 156
Table 24-B. Component List (Software-Selected Termination, Longitudinal Protection)...................................... 157
Table 24-C. Transformer Specifications.................................................................................................................. 158
Table 27-A. Transmit Error-Insertion Setup Sequence ........................................................................................... 180
Table 27-B. Error Insertion Examples..................................................................................................................... 182
Table 34-A. Instruction Codes for IEEE 1149.1 Architecture ................................................................................ 203
Table 34-B. ID Code Structure................................................................................................................................ 204
Table 34-C. Device ID Codes.................................................................................................................................. 204
Table 34-D. Boundary Scan Control Bits................................................................................................................ 205
7 of 238
DS2155
2. DATA SHEET REVISION HISTORY
REVISION
DESCRIPTION
In Section 3: Line Interface and Section 3.1: Functional Description, corrected dB values
for E1 and T1 (page 10 and page 13):
E1: 0 to -43dB and 0 to -12dB
080607
T1: 0 to -15dB and 0 to -36dB
040907
041806
011606
100903
Added Note 1 (GBD for cold temp) to Absolute Maximum Ratings (Section 36).
Replaced Figure 24-3 and Figure 24-4, added Table 24-A and Table 24-B.
Added lead-free packages to Ordering Information table on page 1.
Add revision history table: The previous version of the DS2155 data sheet (12-06-02) did
not incorporate a revision history table and did not describe new features added to B1
revision of the DS2155.
THE FOLLOWING WERE INADVERTENTLY REMOVED FROM THE
PREVIOUS VERSION OF THE DS2155 DATA SHEET:
Add CSBGA package information to Ordering Information table on front page
Add CSBGA package thermal characteristics to Operating Parameters section
Add Transmit Line Build Out Control register (TLBC) description
Add Transmit Line Build Out Control register (TLBC) to Port Map
Add Transmit Line Build Out Control register (TLBC) description to LIU TRANSMIT
section
THE FOLLOWING ARE CORRECTIONS TO ERRORS IN THE PREVIOUS
VERSION OF THE DS2155 DATA SHEET:
Correct Device ID in Device Identification Register
Correct Device ID in JTAG ID Code table
Correct minimum value for tDHW in AC CHARACTERISTICS: MULTIPLEXED
PARALLEL PORT table. tDHW was changed from 5ns to 0ns
Correct minimum value for tDDR in AC CHARACTERISTICS: MULTIPLEXED
PARALLEL PORT table. tDDR was changed from unstated to 20ns
Corrections to AC CHARACTERISTICS: TRANSMIT SIDE timing table.
1. tCP, tCH, tCL, tLP, tLH, tLL, and tSP typical values have been restated to reflect various IBO
modes.
2. tCH, tCL, tLH, tLL minimum values have been changed from 75ns to 20ns.
3. tSP, tLL minimum values have been changed from 50ns to 20ns.
4. tD3 minimum values have been changed from 75ns to 22ns.
Corrections to AC CHARACTERISTICS: RECEIVE SIDE timing table.
1. tCP, tCH, tCL, tLP, tLH, tLL, and tSP typical values have been restated to reflect various IBO
modes.
2. tCH, tCL, minimum values have been changed from 75ns to 20ns.
3. tSH, tSL minimum values have been changed from 50ns to 20ns.
4. tSH, tSL typical values have been added.
5. tD3, tD4 minimum values have been changed from 50ns to 22ns.
Correct Transmit Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format) table in Transmit Signaling
section
8 of 238
DS2155
REVISION
DESCRIPTION
The definition of the EGL bit in the LIC1 register has been corrected for both T1 and E1
mode.
T1 Mode: EGL = 1 was changed from 15dB to –15dB
E1 Mode: EGL = 0 was changed from –10dB to –12dB
THE FOLLOWING ARE FORMAT CHANGES AND ADDED OR REMOVED
TEXT, TABLES OR DIAGRAMS:
Replace X* format for showing active low signals with X
Remove redundant statements about “multiport configurations” in Interrupt Handling
section
Remove BASIC NETWORK CONNECTIONS figure in LINE INTERFACE UNIT
section
Add “Simplified Diagram of BERT in Network Direction” figure to BERT section
Add “Simplified Diagram of BERT in Backplane Direction” figure to BERT section
Add Receive Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format) table to Receive Signaling
section
Add GRIC and GTIC function table to IAAR register
Changed Table of contents to include table of figures and table of tables.
Add note for FASRC bit.
Add T1 and E1 Transmit Flow Chart.
Added RCLK to BPCLK timing diagram.
THE FOLLOWING ARE NEW FEATURES AVAILABLE ON THE DS2155 REV
B1 AND ARE EXPLAINED IN THE BODY OF THE DATA SHEET
Add FRAS0, TCCS, RCCS and GRSRE bits to Signaling Control Register (SIGCR)
Add section on AIS-CI and RAI-CI Generation and Detection
Add RAIS-CI status bit to Status Register 4 (SR4) and Interrupt Mask Register 4 (IMR4)
Add RAIS-CI status bit to Status Register 4 (SR4)
Add TRAI-CI control bit to T1 Common Control Register 1 (TCCR1)
Add TAIS-CI control bit to T1 Common Control Register 1 (TCCR1)
Add Pseudorandom 2E9-1 pattern to PS0, PS1 and PS2 bit description in Bert Control
Register 1 (BCR1)
Add BD bit to Information Register 2 (INFO2)
Add ILUT status bit to Status Register 1 (SR1) and Interrupt Mask Register 1 (IMR1)
Add INTDIS and TMSS bits to Common Control Register 3 (CCR3)
9 of 238
DS2155
3. MAIN FEATURES
The DS2155 contains all of the features of the previous generation of Dallas Semiconductor’s T1 and E1 SCTs plus
many new features.
ꢀ
ꢀ
Transmitter power-down
Transmitter 50mA short-circuit limiter with
current-limit-exceeded indication
General
ꢀ
Programmable output clocks for fractional T1, E1,
H0, and H12 applications
ꢀ
ꢀ
Transmit open-circuit-detected indication
Line interface function can be completely
decoupled from the framer/formatter
ꢀ
ꢀ
Interleaving PCM bus operation
8-bit parallel control port, multiplexed or
nonmultiplexed, Intel or Motorola
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG-Boundary Scan
3.3V supply with 5V tolerant inputs and outputs
Pin compatible with DS2156, DS2152/DS2154,
and DS21x5Y SCT family
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Clock Synthesizer
ꢀ
Output frequencies include 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz,
8.192MHz, and 16.384MHz
Derived from recovered receive clock
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Signaling System 7 Support
RAI-CI, AIS-CI support
Jitter Attenuator
ꢀ
ꢀ
100-pin LQFP (14mm x 14mm) (DS2155L)
100-pin CSBGA (10mm x 10mm) (DS2155G)
3.3V supply with 5V tolerant inputs and outputs
Evaluation kits
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG boundary scan
Driver source code available from the factory
32-bit or 128-bit crystal-less jitter attenuator
Requires only a 2.048MHz master clock for both
E1 and T1 operation with the option to use
1.544MHz for T1 operation
Can be placed in either the receive or transmit path
or disabled
ꢀ
ꢀ
Limit trip indication
Line Interface
Framer/Formatter
ꢀ
Requires only a 2.048MHz master clock for both
E1 and T1 operation with the option to use
1.544MHz for T1 operation
ꢀ
Fully independent transmit and receive
functionality
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Fully software configurable
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Full receive and transmit path transparency
T1 framing formats include D4 (SLC-96) and ESF
Detailed alarm and status reporting with optional
interrupt support
Short-haul and long-haul applications
Automatic receive sensitivity adjustments
Ranges include 0 to -43dB or 0 to -12dB for E1
applications and 0 to -15dB or 0 to -36dB for T1
applications
Receive level indication in 2.5dB steps from
-42.5dB to -2.5dB
Internal receive termination option for 75Ω, 100Ω,
and 120Ω lines
Internal transmit termination option for 75Ω, 100Ω,
and 120Ω lines
Monitor application gain settings of 20dB, 26dB,
and 32dB
G.703 receive synchronization-signal mode
Flexible transmit waveform generation
T1 DSX-1 line buildouts
T1 CSU line buildouts of -7.5dB, -15dB, and
-22.5dB
ꢀ
Large path and line error counters for:
–
–
T1: BPV, CV, CRC6, and framing bit errors
E1: BPV, CV, CRC4, E-bit, and frame
alignment errors
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Timed or manual update modes
DS1 idle code generation on a per-channel basis in
both transmit and receive paths
–
–
User-defined
Digital milliwatt
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ANSI T1.403-1998 Support
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
RAI-CI detection and generation
AIS-CI detection and generation
E1ETS 300 011 RAI generation
G.965 V5.2 link detect
Ability to monitor one DS0 channel in both the
transmit and receive paths
ꢀ
E1 waveforms include G.703 waveshapes for
both 75Ω coax and 120Ω twisted cables
AIS generation independent of loopbacks
Alternating ones and zeros generation
Square-wave output
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
In-band repeating pattern generators and detectors
–
–
Three independent generators and detectors
Patterns from 1 to 8 bits or 16 bits in length
Open-drain output option
NRZ format option
RCL, RLOS, RRA, and RAIS alarms interrupt on
change-of-state
10 of 238
DS2155
Test and Diagnostics
ꢀ
Flexible signaling support
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Programmable on-chip bit error-rate testing
Pseudorandom patterns including QRSS
User-defined repetitive patterns
Daly pattern
–
–
–
Software or hardware based
Interrupt generated on change of signaling data
Receive signaling freeze on loss-of-sync,
carrier loss, or frame slip
Error insertion single and continuous
Total bit and errored bit counts
Payload error insertion
ꢀ
ꢀ
Addition of hardware pins to indicate carrier loss
and signaling freeze
Automatic RAI generation to ETS 300 011
specifications
Error insertion in the payload portion of the T1
frame in the transmit path
ꢀ
ꢀ
Access to Sa and Si bits
ꢀ
ꢀ
Errors can be inserted over the entire frame or
selected channels
Option to extend carrier loss criteria to a 1ms
period as per ETS 300 233
Insertion options include continuous and absolute
number with selectable insertion rates
F-bit corruption for line testing
ꢀ
Japanese J1 support
–
Ability to calculate and check CRC6 according
to the Japanese standard
ꢀ
ꢀ
Loopbacks: remote, local, analog, and per-channel
loopback
–
Ability to generate Yellow Alarm according to
the Japanese standard
Extended System Information Bus
TDM Bus
ꢀ
Host can read interrupt and alarm status on up to 8
ports with a single bus read
ꢀ
Dual two-frame independent receive and transmit
elastic stores
–
–
–
Independent control and clocking
User-Programmable Output Pins
Controlled slip capability with status
Minimum delay mode supported
ꢀ
Four user-defined output pins for controlling
external logic
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
16.384MHz maximum backplane burst rate
Supports T1 to CEPT (E1) conversion
Programmable output clocks for fractional T1, E1,
H0, and H12 applications
Control Port
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
8-bit parallel control port
Multiplexed or nonmultiplexed buses
Intel or Motorola formats
ꢀ
ꢀ
Interleaving PCM bus operation
Hardware signaling capability
Supports polled or interrupt environments
Software access to device ID and silicon revision
Software reset supported
–
–
–
Receive signaling reinsertion to a backplane
multiframe sync
Availability of signaling in a separate PCM
data stream
–
Automatic clear on power-up
ꢀ
Hardware reset pin
Signaling freezing
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Ability to pass the T1 F-bit position through the
elastic stores in the 2.048MHz backplane mode
Access to the data streams in between the
framer/formatter and the elastic stores
User-selectable synthesized clock output
HDLC Controllers
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Two independent HDLC controllers
Fast load and unload features for FIFOs
SS7 support for FISU transmit and receive
Independent 128-byte Rx and Tx buffers with
interrupt support
ꢀ
ꢀ
ꢀ
Access FDL, Sa, or single/multiple DS0 channels
DS0 access includes Nx64 or Nx56
Compatible with polled or interrupt driven
environments
ꢀ
Bit-oriented code (BOC) support
11 of 238
DS2155
The DS2155 is compliant with the following standards:
ANSI:
AT&T:
ITU:
T1.403-1995, T1.231–1993, T1.408
TR54016, TR62411
G.703, G.704, G.706, G.736, G.775, G.823, G.932, I.431, O.151, Q.161
ITU-T:
Recommendation I.432–03/93 B-ISDN User-Network Interface—Physical Layer
Specification
ETSI:
ETS 300 011, ETS 300 166, ETS 300 233, CTR12, CTR4
JTG.703, JTI.431, JJ-20.11 (CMI Coding Only)
Japanese:
12 of 238
DS2155
3.1 Functional Description
The DS2155 is a software-selectable T1, E1, or J1 single-chip transceiver (SCT) for short-haul and long-
haul applications. The DS2155 is composed of an LIU, framer, HDLC controllers, and a TDM backplane
interface, and is controlled by an 8-bit parallel port configured for Intel or Motorola bus operations. The
DS2155 is pin and software compatible with the DS2156.
The LIU is composed of transmit and receive interfaces and a jitter attenuator. The transmit interface is
responsible for generating the necessary waveshapes for driving the network and providing the correct
source impedance depending on the type of media used. T1 waveform generation includes DSX-1 line
buildouts as well as CSU line buildouts of -7.5dB, -15dB, and -22.5dB. E1 waveform generation includes
G.703 waveshapes for both 75Ω coax and 120Ω twisted cables. The receive interface provides network
termination and recovers clock and data from the network. The receive sensitivity adjusts automatically to
the incoming signal and can be programmed for 0 to -43dB or 0 to -12dB for E1 applications and
0 to -15dB or 0 to -36dB for T1 applications. The jitter attenuator removes phase jitter from the
transmitted or received signal. The crystal-less jitter attenuator requires only a 2.048MHz MCLK for both
E1 and T1 applications (with the option of using a 1.544MHz MCLK in T1 applications) and can be
placed in either transmit or receive data paths. An additional feature of the LIU is a CMI coder/decoder
for interfacing to optical networks.
On the transmit side, clock, data, and frame-sync signals are provided to the framer by the backplane
interface section. The framer inserts the appropriate synchronization framing patterns, alarm information,
calculates and inserts the CRC codes, and provides the B8ZS/HDB3 (zero code suppression) and AMI
line coding. The receive-side framer decodes AMI, B8ZS, and HDB3 line coding, synchronizes to the
data stream, reports alarm information, counts framing/coding/CRC errors, and provides clock/data and
frame-sync signals to the backplane interface section.
Both the transmit and receive path have two HDLC controllers. The HDLC controllers transmit and
receive data through the framer block. The HDLC controllers can be assigned to any time slot, group of
time slots, portion of a time slot or to FDL (T1) or Sa bits (E1). Each controller has 128-byte FIFOs, thus
reducing the amount of processor overhead required to manage the flow of data. In addition, built-in
support for reducing the processor time is required in SS7 applications.
The backplane interface provides a versatile method of sending and receiving data from the host system.
Elastic stores provide a method for interfacing to asynchronous systems, converting from a T1/E1
network to a 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or N x 64kHz system backplane. The elastic stores also
manage slip conditions (asynchronous interface). An interleave bus option (IBO) is provided to allow up
to eight transceivers to share a high-speed backplane.
The parallel port provides access for control and configuration of the DS2155’s features. The extended
system information bus (ESIB) function allows up to eight transceivers to be accessed by a single read for
interrupt status or other user-selectable alarm status information. Diagnostic capabilities include
loopbacks, PRBS pattern generation/detection, and 16-bit loop-up and loop-down code generation and
detection.
13 of 238
DS2155
Reader’s Note: This data sheet assumes a particular nomenclature of the T1 operating environment. In
each 125µs frame there are 24 8-bit channels plus a framing bit. It is assumed that the framing bit is sent
first followed by channel 1. Each channel is made up of eight bits that are numbered 1 to 8. Bit number 1
is the MSB and is transmitted first. Bit number 8 is the LSB and is transmitted last. The term “locked” is
used to refer to two clock signals that are phase- or frequency-locked or derived from a common clock
(i.e., a 1.544MHz clock can be locked to a 2.048MHz clock if they share the same 8kHz component).
Throughout this data sheet, the following abbreviations are used:
B8ZS
BOC
CRC
D4
ESF
FDL
FPS
Fs
Ft
HDLC
Bipolar with 8 Zero Substitution
Bit-Oriented Code
Cyclical Redundancy Check
Superframe (12 frames per multiframe) Multiframe Structure
Extended Superframe (24 frames per multiframe) Multiframe Structure
Facility Data Link
Framing Pattern Sequence in ESF
Signaling Framing Pattern in D4
Terminal Framing Pattern in D4
High-Level Data Link Control
MF
Multiframe
SLC–96
Subscriber Loop Carrier—96 Channels
14 of 238
DS2155
3.2 Block Diagram
Figure 3-1 shows a simplified block diagram featuring the major components of the DS2155. Details are
shown in subsequent figures. The block diagram is divided into three functional blocks: LIU, FRAMER,
and BACKPLANE INTERFACE.
Figure 3-1. Block Diagram
CLOCK
EXTERNAL ACCESS
CLOCK
TO RECEIVE SIGNALS
ADAPTER
HDB3 / B8ZS
SYNC
SINGALING
ALARM DET
HDLCs
BACKPLANE
CLOCK SYNTH
RX
MUX
LIU
BACKPLANE
INTERFACE
CIRCUIT
FRAMER
SINGALING
ALARM GEN
HDLCs
CRC GEN
HDB3 / B8ZS
TX
MUX
LIU
EXTERNAL ACCESS
LIU
FRAMER
BACKPLANE
INTERFACE
TO TRANSMIT SIGNALS
JTAG HOST INTERFACE ESIB
15 of 238
DS2155
Figure 3-2. Receive and Transmit LIU
RCL
VCO / PLL
MUX
32.768MHz
JACLK
RPOS
RNEG
RCLK
RRING
RTIP
TRING
TTIP
TPOS
TNEG
TCLK
MUX
16 of 238
DS2155
Figure 3-3. Receive and Transmit Framer/HDLC
REC
REC
HDLC #1
HDLC #2
128 Byte
FIFO
128 Byte
FIFO
MAPPER
MAPPER
DATA
CLOCK
SYNC
DATA
CLOCK
SYNC
SYNC
CLOCK
DATA
RPOS
RNEG
RCLK
RECEIVE
FRAMER
SYNC
TPOS
TNEG
TCLK
TRANSMIT
FRAMER
CLOCK
DATA
MAPPER
MAPPER
XMIT
XMIT
HDLC #1
HDLC #2
128 Byte
FIFO
128 Byte
FIFO
17 of 238
DS2155
Figure 3-4. Backplane Interface
Sa BIT/FDL
RLINK
RLCLK
EXTRACTION
RSIG
RSIGFR
SIGNALING
BUFFER
DATA
CLOCK
SYNC
RSYSCLK
RSER
ELASTIC
STORE
RCLK
RSYNC
RMSYNC
RFSYNC
RDATA
RCHCLK
RCHBLK
CHANNEL
TIMING
SYNC
TSER
SIGNALING
BUFFER
TSIG
Sa/FDL
INSERT
ELASTIC
STORE
DATA
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
TSYNC
CLOCK
TESO
TDATA
TLCLK
TLINK
CHANNEL
TIMING
TCHCLK
TCHBLK
TCLK
MUX
TCLK
JACLK
18 of 238
DS2155
4. PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
4.1 Transmit Side
Signal Name:
TCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Clock
Input
A 1.544MHz (T1) or a 2.048MHz (E1) primary clock. Used to clock data through the transmit-side formatter.
TCLK can be internally sourced from MCLK. This is the most flexible method and requires only a single clock
signal for both T1 or E1. If internal sourcing is used, then the TCLK pin should be connected low.
Signal Name:
TSER
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Serial Data
Input
Transmit NRZ serial data. Sampled on the falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled.
Sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.
Signal Name:
TCHCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Channel Clock
Output
A 192kHz (T1) or 256kHz (E1) clock that pulses high during the LSB of each channel. Can also be programmed to
output a gated transmit bit clock on a per-channel basis. Synchronous with TCLK when the transmit-side elastic
store is disabled. Synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. Useful for parallel-
to-serial conversion of channel data.
Signal Name:
TCHBLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Channel Block
Output
A user-programmable output that can be forced high or low during any of the channels. Synchronous with TCLK
when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is
enabled. Useful for blocking clocks to a serial UART or LAPD controller in applications where not all channels are
used such as Fractional T1, Fractional E1, 384kbps (H0), 768kbps, or ISDN–PRI. Also useful for locating
individual channels in drop-and-insert applications, for external per-channel loopback, and for per-channel
conditioning.
Signal Name:
TSYSCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit System Clock
Input
1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or 16.384MHz clock. Only used when the transmit-side elastic
store function is enabled. Should be connected low in applications that do not use the transmit-side elastic store.
See Section 28 for details on 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, and 16.384MHz operation using the IBO.
Signal Name:
TLCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Link Clock
Output
Demand clock for the transmit link data [TLINK] input.
T1 Mode: A 4kHz or 2kHz (ZBTSI) clock.
E1 Mode: A 4kHz to 20kHz clock.
19 of 238
DS2155
Signal Name:
TLINK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Link Data
Input
If enabled, this pin is sampled on the falling edge of TCLK for data insertion into either the FDL stream (ESF) or
the Fs-bit position (D4), or the Z-bit position (ZBTSI) or any combination of the Sa-bit positions (E1).
Signal Name:
TSYNC
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Sync
Input/Output
A pulse at this pin establishes either frame or multiframe boundaries for the transmit side. Can be programmed to
output either a frame or multiframe pulse. If this pin is set to output pulses at frame boundaries, it can also be set by
IOCR1.3 to output double-wide pulses at signaling frames in T1 mode.
Signal Name:
TSSYNC
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit System Sync
Input
Only used when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. A pulse at this pin establishes either frame or multiframe
boundaries for the transmit side. Should be connected low in applications that do not use the transmit-side elastic
store.
Signal Name:
TSIG
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Signaling Input
Input
When enabled, this input samples signaling bits for insertion into outgoing PCM data stream. Sampled on the
falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK
when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.
Signal Name:
TESO
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Elastic Store Data Output
Output
Updated on the rising edge of TCLK with data out of the transmit-side elastic store whether the elastic store is
enabled or not. This pin is normally connected to TDATA.
Signal Name:
TDATA
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Data
Input
Sampled on the falling edge of TCLK with data to be clocked through the transmit-side formatter. This pin is
normally connected to TESO.
Signal Name:
TPOSO
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Positive-Data Output
Output
Updated on the rising edge of TCLKO with the bipolar data out of the transmit-side formatter. Can be programmed
to source NRZ data by the output data format (IOCR1.0) control bit. This pin is normally connected to TPOSI.
Signal Name:
TNEGO
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Negative-Data Output
Output
Updated on the rising edge of TCLKO with the bipolar data out of the transmit-side formatter. This pin is normally
connected to TNEGI.
Signal Name:
TCLKO
20 of 238
DS2155
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Clock Output
Output
Buffered clock that is used to clock data through the transmit-side formatter (i.e., either TCLK or RCLKI). This pin
is normally connected to TCLKI.
Signal Name:
TPOSI
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Positive-Data Input
Input
Sampled on the falling edge of TCLKI for data to be transmitted out onto the T1 line. Can be internally connected
to TPOSO by connecting the LIUC pin high. TPOSI and TNEGI can be connected together in NRZ applications.
Signal Name:
TNEGI
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Negative-Data Input
Input
Sampled on the falling edge of TCLKI for data to be transmitted out onto the T1 line. Can be internally connected
to TNEGO by connecting the LIUC pin high. TPOSI and TNEGI can be connected together in NRZ applications.
Signal Name:
TCLKI
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Clock Input
Input
Line interface transmit clock. Can be internally connected to TCLKO by connecting the LIUC pin high.
4.2 Receive Side
Signal Name:
RLINK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Link Data
Output
T1 Mode: Updated with either FDL data (ESF) or Fs bits (D4) or Z bits (ZBTSI) one RCLK before the start of a
frame.
E1 Mode: Updated with the full E1 data stream on the rising edge of RCLK.
Signal Name:
RLCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Link Clock
Output
T1 Mode: A 4kHz or 2kHz (ZBTSI) clock for the RLINK output.
E1 Mode: A 4kHz to 20kHz clock.
Signal Name:
RCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Clock
Output
1.544MHz (T1) or 2.048MHz (E1) clock that is used to clock data through the receive-side framer.
Signal Name:
RCHCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Channel Clock
Output
A 192kHz (T1) or 256kHz (E1) clock that pulses high during the LSB of each channel. Synchronous with RCLK
when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is
enabled. Useful for parallel-to-serial conversion of channel data.
21 of 238
DS2155
Signal Name:
RCHBLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Channel Block
Output
A user-programmable output that can be forced high or low during any of the 24 T1 or 32 E1 channels.
Synchronous with RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with RSYSCLK when the
receive-side elastic store is enabled. Useful for blocking clocks to a serial UART or LAPD controller in
applications where not all channels are used such as fractional service, 384kbps service, 768kbps, or ISDN–PRI.
Also useful for locating individual channels in drop-and-insert applications, for external per-channel loopback, and
for per-channel conditioning. See Section 18 for details.
Signal Name:
RSER
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Serial Data
Output
Received NRZ serial data. Updated on rising edges of RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is disabled.
Updated on the rising edges of RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is enabled.
Signal Name:
RSYNC
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Sync
Input/Output
An extracted pulse, one RCLK wide, is output at this pin that identifies either frame (IOCR1.5 = 0) or multiframe
(IOCR1.5 = 1) boundaries. If set to output frame boundaries, then through IOCR1.6, RSYNC can also be set to
output double-wide pulses on signaling frames in T1 mode. If the receive-side elastic store is enabled, then this pin
can be enabled to be an input through IOCR1.4, at which a frame or multiframe boundary pulse is applied.
Signal Name:
RFSYNC
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Frame Sync
Output
An extracted 8kHz pulse, one RCLK wide, is output at this pin that identifies frame boundaries.
Signal Name:
RMSYNC
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Multiframe Sync
Output
An extracted pulse, one RCLK wide (elastic store disabled) or one RSYSCLK wide (elastic store enabled), is
output at this pin that identifies multiframe boundaries.
Signal Name:
RDATA
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Data
Output
Updated on the rising edge of RCLK with the data out of the receive-side framer.
Signal Name:
RSYSCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive System Clock
Input
1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, or 8.192MHz clock. Only used when the receive-side elastic store function is
enabled. Should be connected low in applications that do not use the receive-side elastic store. See Section 28 for
details on 4.096MHz and 8.192MHz operation using the IBO.
Signal Name:
RSIG
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Signaling Output
Output
Outputs signaling bits in a PCM format. Updated on rising edges of RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is
disabled. Updated on the rising edges of RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is enabled.
22 of 238
DS2155
Signal Name:
RLOS/LOTC
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Loss-of-Sync/Loss-of-Transmit Clock
Output
A dual function output that is controlled by the CCR1.0 control bit. This pin can be programmed to either toggle
high when the synchronizer is searching for the frame and multiframe or to toggle high if the TCLK pin has not
been toggled for 5µs.
Signal Name:
RCL
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Carrier Loss
Output
Set high when the line interface detects a carrier loss.
Signal Name:
RSIGF
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Signaling Freeze
Output
Set high when the signaling data is frozen by either automatic or manual intervention. Used to alert downstream
equipment of the condition.
Signal Name:
BPCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Backplane Clock
Output
A user-selectable synthesized clock output that is referenced to the clock that is output at the RCLK pin.
Signal Name:
RPOSO
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Positive-Data Output
Output
Updated on the rising edge of RCLKO with bipolar data out of the line interface. This pin is normally connected to
RPOSI.
Signal Name:
RNEGO
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Negative-Data Output
Output
Updated on the rising edge of RCLKO with the bipolar data out of the line interface. This pin is normally
connected to RNEGI.
Signal Name:
RCLKO
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Clock Output
Output
Buffered recovered clock from the network. This pin is normally connected to RCLKI.
Signal Name:
RPOSI
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Positive-Data Input
Input
Sampled on the falling edge of RCLKI for data to be clocked through the receive-side framer. RPOSI and RNEGI
can be connected together for an NRZ interface. Can be internally connected to RPOSO by connecting the LIUC
pin high.
Signal Name:
RNEGI
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Negative-Data Input
Input
Sampled on the falling edge of RCLKI for data to be clocked through the receive-side framer. RPOSI and RNEGI
can be connected together for an NRZ interface. Can be internally connected to RNEGO by connecting the LIUC
pin high.
23 of 238
DS2155
Signal Name:
RCLKI
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Clock Input
Input
Clock used to clock data through the receive-side framer. This pin is normally connected to RCLKO. Can be
internally connected to RCLKO by connecting the LIUC pin high.
4.3 Parallel Control Port Pins
INT
Signal Name:
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Interrupt
Output
Flags host controller during conditions and events defined in the status registers. Active-low, open-drain output.
Signal Name:
TSTRST
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Tri-State Control and Device Reset
Input
A dual function pin. A 0-to-1 transition issues a hardware reset to the DS2155 register set. A reset clears all
configuration registers. Configuration register contents are set to 0. Leaving TSTRST high tri-states all output and
I/O pins (including the parallel control port). Set low for normal operation. Useful in board-level testing.
Signal Name:
MUX
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Bus Operation
Input
Set low to select nonmultiplexed bus operation. Set high to select multiplexed bus operation.
Signal Name:
AD0 to AD7
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Data Bus [D0 to D7] or Address/Data Bus
Input/Output
In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), these serve as the data bus. In multiplexed bus operation (MUX = 1),
these pins serve as an 8-bit multiplexed address/data bus.
Signal Name:
A0 to A6
Address Bus
Input
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), these serve as the address bus. In multiplexed bus operation
(MUX = 1), these pins are not used and should be connected low.
Signal Name:
BTS
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Bus Type Select
Input
Strap high to select Motorola bus timing; strap low to select Intel bus timing. This pin controls the function of the
RD (DS), ALE (AS), and WR (R/W) pins.
If BTS = 1, then these pins assume the function listed in parentheses ().
Signal Name:
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
RD (DS)
Read Input, Data Strobe
Input
In Intel mode, RD determines when data is read from the device. In Motorola mode, DS is used to write to the
device. See Bus Timing Diagrams.
24 of 238
DS2155
Signal Name:
CS
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Chip Select
Input
Must be low to read or write to the device. CS is an active-low signal.
Signal Name:
ALE(AS)/A7
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Address Latch Enable (Address Strobe) or A7
Input
In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), serves as the upper address bit. In multiplexed bus operation
(MUX = 1), serves to demultiplex the bus on a positive-going edge.
Signal Name:
WR (R/W)
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Write Input(Read/Write)
Input
WR is an active-low signal.
4.4 Extended System Information Bus
Signal Name:
ESIBS0
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Extended System Information Bus Select 0
Input/Output
Used to group two to eight DS2155s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See Section 29 for
more details.
Signal Name:
ESIBS1
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Extended System Information Bus Select 1
Input/Output
Used to group two to eight DS2155s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See Section 29 for
more details.
Signal Name:
ESIBRD
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Extended System Information Bus Read
Input/Output
Used to group two to eight DS2155s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See Section 29 for
more details.
25 of 238
DS2155
4.5 User Output Port Pins
Signal Name:
UOP0
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
User Output Port 0
Output
This output port pin can be set low or high by the CCR4.0 control bit. This pin is forced low on power-up and after
any device reset.
Signal Name:
UOP1
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
User Output Port 1
Output
This output port pin can be set low or high by the CCR4.1 control bit. This pin is forced low on power-up and after
any device reset.
Signal Name:
UOP2
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
User Output Port 2
Output
This output port pin can be set low or high by the CCR4.2 control bit. This pin is forced low on power-up and after
any device reset.
Signal Name:
UOP3
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
User Output Port 3
Output
This output port pin can be set low or high by the CCR4.3 control bit. This pin is forced low on power-up and after
any device reset.
26 of 238
DS2155
4.6 JTAG Test Access Port Pins
Signal Name:
JTRST
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
IEEE 1149.1 Test Reset
Input
JTRST is used to asynchronously reset the test access port controller. After power-up, JTRST must be toggled from
low to high. This action sets the device into the JTAG DEVICE ID mode. Normal device operation is restored by
pulling JTRST low. JTRST is pulled high internally by a 10kΩ resistor operation.
Signal Name:
JTMS
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
IEEE 1149.1 Test Mode Select
Input
This pin is sampled on the rising edge of JTCLK and is used to place the test access port into the various defined
IEEE 1149.1 states. This pin has a 10kΩ pullup resistor.
Signal Name:
JTCLK
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
IEEE 1149.1 Test Clock Signal
Input
This signal is used to shift data into JTDI on the rising edge and out of JTDO on the falling edge.
Signal Name:
JTDI
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Input
Input
Test instructions and data are clocked into this pin on the rising edge of JTCLK. This pin has a 10kΩ pullup
resistor.
Signal Name:
JTDO
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Output
Output
Test instructions and data are clocked out of this pin on the falling edge of JTCLK. If not used, this pin should be
left unconnected.
27 of 238
DS2155
4.7 Line Interface Pins
Signal Name:
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
MCLK
Master Clock Input
Input
A (50ppm) clock source is applied at this pin. This clock is used internally for both clock/data recovery and for the
jitter attenuator for T1 and E1 modes. A quartz crystal of 2.048MHz can be applied across MCLK and XTALD
instead of the clock source. The clock rate can be 16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, or 2.048MHz. When using
the DS2155 in T1-only operation, a 1.544MHz (50ppm) clock source can be used.
Signal Name:
XTALD
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Quartz Crystal Driver
Output
A quartz crystal of 2.048MHz (optional 1.544MHz in T1-only operation) can be applied across MCLK and
XTALD instead of a clock source at MCLK. Leave open circuited if a clock source is applied at MCLK.
Signal Name:
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
8XCLK
Eight Times Clock (8x)
Output
An 8x clock that is locked to the recovered network clock provided from the clock/data recovery block (if
the jitter attenuator is enabled on the receive side) or from the TCLKI pin (if the jitter attenuator is
enabled on the transmit side).
Signal Name:
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
LIUC
Line Interface Connect
Input
Connect low to separate the line interface circuitry from the framer/formatter circuitry and activate the
TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins. Connect high to connect the line interface circuitry to the
framer/formatter circuitry and deactivate the TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins. When LIUC is
connected high, the TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins should be connected low.
Signal Name:
RTIP and RRING
Receive Tip and Ring
Input
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Analog inputs for clock recovery circuitry. These pins connect through a 1:1 transformer to the network. See
Section 24 for details.
Signal Name:
TTIP and TRING
Transmit Tip and Ring
Output
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Analog line driver outputs. These pins connect through a 1:2 step-up transformer to the network. See Section 24 for
details.
28 of 238
DS2155
4.8 Supply Pins
Signal Name:
DVDD
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Digital Positive Supply
Supply
3.3V ±5%. Should be connected to the RVDD and TVDD pins.
Signal Name:
RVDD
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Analog Positive Supply
Supply
3.3V ±5%. Should be connected to the DVDD and TVDD pins.
Signal Name:
TVDD
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Analog Positive Supply
Supply
3.3V ±5%. Should be connected to the RVDD and DVDD pins.
Signal Name:
DVSS
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Digital Signal Ground
Supply
Should be connected to the RVSS and TVSS pins.
Signal Name:
RVSS
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Receive Analog Signal Ground
Supply
0V. Should be connected to DVSS and TVSS.
Signal Name:
TVSS
Signal Description:
Signal Type:
Transmit Analog Signal Ground
Supply
0V. Should be connected to DVSS and RVSS.
29 of 238
DS2155
4.9 L and G Package Pinout
The DS2155 is available in either a 100-pin LQFP (L) or 10mm CSBGA, 0.8mm pitch (G) package.
Table 4-A. Pin Description Sorted by Pin Number
PIN
SYMBOL
TYPE
FUNCTION
LQFP
CSBGA
1
A1
RCHBLK
JTMS
O
I
Receive Channel Block
IEEE 1149.1 Test Mode Select
Backplane Clock
IEEE 1149.1 Test Clock Signal
IEEE 1149.1 Test Reset
Receive Carrier Loss
IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Input
User Output 0
2
B2
3
C3
BPCLK
JTCLK
JTRST
RCL
O
I
4
B1
5
D4
I
6
C2
O
I
7
C1
JTDI
8
D3
UOP0
O
O
O
I
9
D2
UOP1
User Output 1
10
D1
JTDO
IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Output
Bus Type Select
Line Interface Connect
Eight Times Clock
11
E3
BTS
12
E2
LIUC
I
13
E1
8XCLK
TSTRST
UOP2
O
I
14
E4
Test/Reset
User Output 2
15
E5
O
I
16
F1
RTIP
Receive Analog Tip Input
Receive Analog Ring Input
Receive Analog Positive Supply
Receive Analog Signal Ground
Master Clock Input
Quartz Crystal Driver
User Output 3
17
F2
RRING
RVDD
RVSS
I
18
F3
—
—
I
19, 20, 24
F4, G1, J1
21
G2
MCLK
XTALD
UOP3
22
H1
O
O
O
—
—
O
–
23
G3
25
H2
INT
Interrupt
26
K1
N.C.
Reserved for Factory Test
Reserved for Factory Test
Transmit Analog Tip Output
Transmit Analog Signal Ground
Transmit Analog Positive Supply
Transmit Analog Ring Output
Transmit Channel Block
Transmit Link Clock
27, 28
J2, H3
N.C.
29
K2
TTIP
30
G4
TVSS
31
J3
TVDD
TRING
TCHBLK
TLCLK
TLINK
ESIBS0
TSYNC
TPOSI
TNEGI
TCLKI
TCLKO
TNEGO
TPOSO
DVDD
DVSS
TCLK
TSER
–
32
K3
O
O
O
I
33
H4
34
J4
35
K4
Transmit Link Data
Extended System Information Bus 0
Transmit Sync
36
H5
I/O
I/O
I
I
I
O
O
O
—
—
I
37
J5
38
K5
Transmit Positive-Data Input
Transmit Negative-Data Input
Transmit Clock Input
Transmit Clock Output
Transmit Negative-Data Output
Transmit Positive-Data Output
Digital Positive Supply
Digital Signal Ground
Transmit Clock
39
G5
40
F5
41
K6
42
J6
43
H6
44, 61, 81, 83
K7, F8, B8, C7
G6, G10, D7, B7
45, 60, 80, 84
46
47
48
49
50
J7
K8
H7
K9
J8
I
I
O
I
Transmit Serial Data
TSIG
Transmit Signaling Input
Transmit Elastic Store Output
Transmit Data
TESO
TDATA
30 of 238
DS2155
PIN
SYMBOL
TYPE
FUNCTION
LQFP
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
82
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
CSBGA
K10
J9
TSYSCLK
TSSYNC
TCHCLK
ESIBS1
MUX
I
I
O
I/O
I
Transmit System Clock
Transmit System Sync
Transmit Channel Clock
Extended System Information Bus 1
Bus Operation
H8
J10
G7
H9
H10
G8
G9
F9
D0/AD0
D1/AD1
D2/AD2
D3/AD3
D4/AD4
D5/AD5
D6/AD6
D7/AD7
A0
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I
Data Bus Bit0/Address/Data Bus Bit 0
Data Bus Bit1/Address/Data Bus Bit 1
Data Bus Bit 2/Address/Data Bus 2
Data Bus Bit 3/Address/Data Bus Bit 3
Data Bus Bit4/Address/Data Bus Bit 4
Data Bus Bit 5/Address/Data Bus Bit 5
Data Bus Bit 6/Address/Data Bus Bit 6
Data Bus Bit 7/Address/Data Bus Bit 7
Address Bus Bit 0
F10
F7
F6
E10
E9
A1
I
Address Bus Bit 1
E8
A2
I
Address Bus Bit 2
D10
E7
A3
I
Address Bus Bit 3
A4
I
Address Bus Bit 4
D9
C10
D8
B10
C9
A5
I
Address Bus Bit 5
A6
I
Address Bus Bit 6
ALE (AS)/A7
RD (DS)
CS
I
Address Latch Enable/Address Bus Bit 7
Read Input (Data Strobe)
Chip Select
I
I
A10
B9
C8
ESIBRD
WR (R/W)
RLINK
RLCLK
RCLK
RDATA
RPOSI
RNEGI
RCLKI
RCLKO
RNEGO
RPOSO
RCHCLK
RSIGF
RSIG
RSER
RMSYNC
RFSYNC
RSYNC
RLOS/LOTC
RSYSCLK
I/O
I
Extended System Information Bus Read
Write Input (Read/Write)
Receive Link Data
O
O
O
O
I
I
I
A9
A8
A7
C6
Receive Link Clock
Receive Clock
Receive Data
Receive Positive-Data Input
Receive Negative-Data Input
Receive Clock Input
B6
A6
D6
E6
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
I/O
O
I
Receive Clock Output
Receive Negative-Data Output
Receive Positive-Data Output
Receive Channel Clock
A5
B5
C5
A4
D5
B4
A3
C4
A2
B3
Receive Signaling-Freeze Output
Receive Signaling Output
Receive Serial Data
Receive Multiframe Sync
Receive Frame Sync
Receive Sync
Receive Loss-of-Sync/Loss-of-Transmit Clock
Receive System Clock
31 of 238
DS2155
4.1010mm CSBGA Pin Configuration
Figure 4-1. 10mm CSBGA Pin Configuration
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
A
B
C
D
E
F
RLOS/
RCHBLK
RFSYNC
RSIG
RPOSO
RCLKI
RDATA
RCLK
RLCLK
ESIBRD
LOTC
WR
(R/W)
RD
(DS)
JTCLK
JTDI
JTMS
RSYSCLK RMSYNC RCHCLK RNEGI
DVSS
DVDD
DVSS
A4
DVDD
RLINK
RCL
UOP1
LIUC
RRING
MCLK
INT
BPCLK
UOP0
BTS
RSYNC
JTRST
TSTRST
RVSS
RSIGF
RSER
UOP2
TCLKI
TNEGI
RPOSI
RCLKO
RNEGO
A6
A3
CS
A5
ALE(AS)/
A7
JTDO
8XCLK
RTIP
A2
A1
A0
RVDD
UOP3
N.C.
D7/AD7 D6/AD6
DVDD
D4/AD4
D3/AD3
D0/AD0
TSSYNC
TESO
D5/AD5
DVSS
D1/AD1
ESIBS1
TSYSCLK
G
H
J
RVSS
XTALD
RVSS
TUSEL
TVSS
DVSS
MUX
TSIG
TCLK
DVDD
D2/AD2
TCHCLK
TDATA
TSER
TCHBLK
TLCLK
TLINK
ESIBS0 TPOSO
TSYNC TNEGO
N.C.
TVDD
TRING
K
TTIP
TPOSI
TCLKO
TOP VIEW
32 of 238
DS2155
5. PARALLEL PORT
The SCT is controlled by either a nonmultiplexed (MUX = 0) or a multiplexed (MUX = 1) bus through an
external microcontroller or microprocessor. The SCT can operate with either Intel or Motorola bus timing
configurations. If the BTS pin is connected low, Intel timing is selected; if connected high, Motorola
timing is selected. All Motorola bus signals are listed in parentheses (). See the timing diagrams in AC
Electrical Characteristics in Section 37 for more details.
5.1 Register Map
Table 5-A. Register Map Sorted by Address
ADDRESS
R/W
REGISTER NAME
SYMBOL
PAGE
xxh
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
0A
0B
0C
0D
0E
0F
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
1A
1B
1C
1D
1E
1F
20
21
22
23
24
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
Master Mode Register
MSTRREG
IOCR1
IOCR2
T1RCR1
T1RCR2
T1TCR1
T1TCR2
T1CCR1
SSIE1
SSIE2
SSIE3
SSIE4
T1RDMR1
T1RDMR2
T1RDMR3
IDR
40
69
I/O Configuration Register 1
I/O Configuration Register 2
T1 Receive Control Register 1
T1 Receive Control Register 2
T1 Transmit Control Register 1
T1 Transmit Control Register 2
T1 Common Control Register 1
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 2
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 3
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 4
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 1
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 2
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 3
Device Identification Register
Information Register 1
70
46
47
48
49
50
93
93
94
94
52
52
52
63
R/W
R
INFO1
INFO2
INFO3
—
53
Information Register 2
153
60
R/W
—
R
R
Information Register 3
Unused
—
Interrupt Information Register 1
Interrupt Information Register 2
Status Register 1
IIR1
42
IIR2
42
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
SR1
154
155
63
Interrupt Mask Register 1
Status Register 2
IMR1
SR2
Interrupt Mask Register 2
Status Register 3
IMR2
64
SR3
65
Interrupt Mask Register 3
Status Register 4
IMR3
66
SR4
67
Interrupt Mask Register 4
Status Register 5
IMR4
68
SR5
106
106
135
136
135
136
112
Interrupt Mask Register 5
Status Register 6
IMR5
SR6
Interrupt Mask Register 6
Status Register 7
IMR6
SR7
Interrupt Mask Register 7
Status Register 8
IMR7
SR8
33 of 238
DS2155
ADDRESS
xxh
25
R/W
REGISTER NAME
SYMBOL
PAGE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
W
Interrupt Mask Register 8
IMR8
SR9
112
174
175
43
26
Status Register 9
27
Interrupt Mask Register 9
IMR9
28
Per-Channel Pointer Register
PCPR
29
Per-Channel Data Register 1
PCDR1
PCDR2
PCDR3
PCDR4
INFO4
INFO5
INFO6
INFO7
H1RC
44
2A
2B
2C
2D
2E
2F
30
W
Per-Channel Data Register 2
44
W
Per-Channel Data Register 3
44
W
Per-Channel Data Register 4
44
R/W
R
Information Register 4
137
137
137
60
Information Register 5
R
R
Information Register 6
Information Register 7
31
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
HDLC #1 Receive Control
129
129
55
32
HDLC #2 Receive Control
H2RC
33
E1 Receive Control Register 1
E1RCR1
E1RCR2
E1TCR1
E1TCR2
BOCC
34
E1 Receive Control Register 2
56
35
E1 Transmit Control Register 1
E1 Transmit Control Register 2
BOC Control Register
57
36
58
37
111
88
38
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information 1
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information 2
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information 3
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information 4
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable 1
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable 2
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable 3
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable 4
Signaling Control Register
RSINFO1
RSINFO2
RSINFO3
RSINFO4
RSCSE1
RSCSE2
RSCSE3
RSCSE4
SIGCR
ERCNT
LCVCR1
LCVCR2
PCVCR1
PCVCR2
FOSCR1
FOSCR2
EBCR1
EBCR2
LBCR
39
88
3A
3B
3C
3D
3E
3F
40
88
88
88
88
88
88
85
41
Error Count Configuration Register
Line Code Violation Count Register 1
Line Code Violation Count Register 2
Path Code Violation Count Register 1
Path Code Violation Count Register 2
Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register 1
Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register 2
E-Bit Count Register 1
75
42
77
43
R
77
44
R
78
45
R
78
46
R
79
47
R
79
48
R
80
49
R
E-Bit Count Register 2
Loopback Control Register
80
4A
4B
4C
4D
4E
4F
50
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
71
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 1
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 2
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 3
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 4
Elastic Store Control Register
PCLR1
PCLR2
PCLR3
PCLR4
ESCR
73
73
74
74
105
91
Transmit Signaling Register 1
TS1
51
Transmit Signaling Register 2
TS2
91
52
Transmit Signaling Register 3
TS3
91
53
Transmit Signaling Register 4
TS4
91
34 of 238
DS2155
ADDRESS
xxh
54
R/W
REGISTER NAME
SYMBOL
PAGE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
Transmit Signaling Register 5
TS5
TS6
91
91
91
91
91
91
91
91
91
91
91
91
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
86
62
191
192
149
81
81
82
82
147
150
151
152
—
149
98
98
99
99
99
55
Transmit Signaling Register 6
Transmit Signaling Register 7
Transmit Signaling Register 8
Transmit Signaling Register 9
Transmit Signaling Register 10
Transmit Signaling Register 11
Transmit Signaling Register 12
Transmit Signaling Register 13
Transmit Signaling Register 14
Transmit Signaling Register 15
Transmit Signaling Register 16
Receive Signaling Register 1
Receive Signaling Register 2
Receive Signaling Register 3
Receive Signaling Register 4
Receive Signaling Register 5
Receive Signaling Register 6
Receive Signaling Register 7
Receive Signaling Register 8
Receive Signaling Register 9
Receive Signaling Register 10
Receive Signaling Register 11
Receive Signaling Register 12
Receive Signaling Register 13
Receive Signaling Register 14
Receive Signaling Register 15
Receive Signaling Register 16
Common Control Register 1
Common Control Register 2
Common Control Register 3
Common Control Register 4
Transmit Channel Monitor Select
Transmit DS0 Monitor Register
Receive Channel Monitor Select
Receive DS0 Monitor Register
Line Interface Control 1
56
TS7
57
TS8
58
TS9
59
TS10
TS11
TS12
TS13
TS14
TS15
TS16
RS1
5A
5B
5C
5D
5E
5F
60
61
R
RS2
62
R
RS3
63
R
RS4
64
R
RS5
65
R
RS6
66
R
RS7
67
R
RS8
68
R
RS9
69
R
RS10
RS11
RS12
RS13
RS14
RS15
RS16
CCR1
CCR2
CCR3
CCR4
TDS0SEL
TDS0M
RDS0SEL
RDS0M
LIC1
LIC2
LIC3
LIC4
—
6A
6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
70
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
71
72
73
74
75
76
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
77
78
79
Line Interface Control 2
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
80
Line Interface Control 3
Line Interface Control 4
Unused
Transmit Line Build-Out Control
Idle Array Address Register
Per-Channel Idle Code Value Register
Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 1
Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 2
Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 3
TLBC
IAAR
PCICR
TCICE1
TCICE2
TCICE3
81
82
35 of 238
DS2155
ADDRESS
xxh
83
R/W
REGISTER NAME
SYMBOL
PAGE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 4
Receive Idle Code Enable Register 1
Receive Idle Code Enable Register 2
Receive Idle Code Enable Register 3
Receive Idle Code Enable Register 4
Receive Channel Blocking Register 1
Receive Channel Blocking Register 2
Receive Channel Blocking Register 3
Receive Channel Blocking Register 4
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 1
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 2
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 3
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 4
HDLC #1 Transmit Control
TCICE4
RCICE1
RCICE2
RCICE3
RCICE4
RCBR1
RCBR2
RCBR3
RCBR4
TCBR1
TCBR2
TCBR3
TCBR4
H1TC
99
84
100
100
100
100
101
101
102
102
103
103
103
103
128
130
131
131
131
131
132
133
133
133
133
134
138
139
139
138
128
130
131
131
131
131
132
133
133
133
133
134
138
139
139
138
188
189
85
86
87
88
89
8A
8B
8C
8D
8E
8F
90
91
HDLC #1 FIFO Control
H1FC
92
HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 1
HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 2
HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 3
HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 4
HDLC #1 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select
HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select1
HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select2
HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select3
HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select4
HDLC #1 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select
HDLC #1 Receive Packet Bytes Available
HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO
H1RCS1
H1RCS2
H1RCS3
H1RCS4
H1RTSBS
H1TCS1
H1TCS2
H1TCS3
H1TCS4
H1TTSBS
H1RPBA
H1TF
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
9A
9B
9C
9D
9E
W
R
HDLC #1 Receive FIFO
H1RF
9F
R
HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available
HDLC #2 Transmit Control
H1TFBA
H2TC
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
AA
AB
AC
AD
AE
AF
B0
B1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
HDLC #2 FIFO Control
H2FC
HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 1
HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 2
HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 3
HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 4
HDLC #2 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select
HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select1
HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select2
HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select3
HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select4
HDLC #2 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select
HDLC #2 Receive Packet Bytes Available
HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO
H2RCS1
H2RCS2
H2RCS3
H2RCS4
H2RTSBS
H2TCS1
H2TCS2
H2TCS3
H2TCS4
H2TTSBS
H2RPBA
H2TF
W
R
HDLC #2 Receive FIFO
H2RF
R
HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available
Extend System Information Bus Control Register 1
Extend System Information Bus Control Register 2
H2TFBA
ESIBCR1
ESIBCR2
R/W
R/W
36 of 238
DS2155
ADDRESS
xxh
B2
R/W
REGISTER NAME
SYMBOL
PAGE
R
Extend System Information Bus Register 1
Extend System Information Bus Register 2
Extend System Information Bus Register 3
Extend System Information Bus Register 4
In-Band Code Control Register
Transmit Code Definition Register 1
Transmit Code Definition Register 2
Receive Up Code Definition Register 1
Receive Up Code Definition Register 2
Receive Down Code Definition Register 1
Receive Down Code Definition Register 2
In-Band Receive Spare Control Register
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 1
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 2
Receive FDL Register
ESIB1
ESIB2
ESIB3
ESIB4
IBCC
190
190
190
190
164
165
165
166
166
167
167
168
169
169
141
142
141
141
—
185
114
114
116
117
117
118
118
119
119
120
115
115
120
121
121
122
122
123
123
124
125
175
176
176
176
176
172
B3
R
B4
R
B5
R
B6
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
B7
TCD1
TCD2
RUPCD1
RUPCD2
RDNCD1
RDNCD2
RSCC
RSCD1
RSCD2
RFDL
TFDL
RFDLM1
RFDLM2
—
B8
B9
BA
BB
BC
BD
BE
BF
C0
C1
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
Transmit FDL Register
C2
Receive FDL Match Register 1
Receive FDL Match Register 2
Unused
C3
C4
C5
R/W
R
Interleave Bus Operation Control Register
Receive Align Frame Register
Receive Nonalign Frame Register
Receive Si Align Frame
IBOC
RAF
C6
C7
R
RNAF
RSiAF
RSiNAF
RRA
C8
R
C9
R
Receive Si Nonalign Frame
CA
CB
CC
CD
CE
CF
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
DA
DB
DC
DD
DE
DF
E0
R
Receive Remote Alarm Bits
Receive Sa4 Bits
R
RSa4
R
Receive Sa5 Bits
RSa5
R
Receive Sa6 Bits
RSa6
R
Receive Sa7 Bits
RSa7
R
Receive Sa8 Bits
RSa8
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Transmit Align Frame Register
Transmit Nonalign Frame Register
Transmit Si Align Frame
TAF
TNAF
TSiAF
TSiNAF
TRA
Transmit Si Nonalign Frame
Transmit Remote Alarm Bits
Transmit Sa4 Bits
TSa4
Transmit Sa5 Bits
TSa5
Transmit Sa6 Bits
TSa6
Transmit Sa7 Bits
TSa7
Transmit Sa8 Bits
TSa8
Transmit Sa Bit Control Register
BERT Alternating Word Count Rate
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4
BERT Control Register 1
TSACR
BAWC
BRP1
BRP2
BRP3
BRP4
BC1
37 of 238
DS2155
ADDRESS
xxh
E1
R/W
REGISTER NAME
SYMBOL
PAGE
R/W
—
R
BERT Control Register 2
BC2
—
173
—
E2
Unused
E3
BERT Bit Count Register 1
BERT Bit Count Register 2
BERT Bit Count Register 3
BERT Bit Count Register 4
BERT Error Count Register 1
BERT Error Count Register 2
BERT Error Count Register 3
BERT Interface Control Register
Error Rate Control Register
Number-of-Errors 1
BBC1
BBC2
BBC3
BBC4
BEC1
BEC2
BEC3
BIC
177
177
177
177
178
178
178
179
181
182
182
183
183
—
E4
R
E5
R
E6
R
E7
R
E8
R
E9
R
EA
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
EB
ERC
EC
NOE1
NOE2
NOEL1
NOEL2
TEST
TEST
TEST
ED
Number-of-Errors 2
EE
Number-of-Errors Left 1
Number-of-Errors Left 2
Test Register
EF
R
F0*
—
—
—
F1–F9*
Test Register
Test Register
—
—
FA–FF*
*TEST1 to TEST16 registers are used only by the factory.
38 of 238
DS2155
6. PROGRAMMING MODEL
The DS2155 register map is divided into three groups: T1 specific features, E1 specific features, and
common features. The typical programming sequence begins with issuing a reset to the DS2155, selecting
T1 or E1 operation in the master mode register, enabling T1 or E1 functions and enabling the common
functions. The act of resetting the DS2155 automatically clears all configuration and status registers.
Therefore, it is not necessary to load unused registers with 0s.
Figure 6-1. Programming Sequence
POWER-ON
ISSUE RESET
SELECT T1 OR E1 OPERATION
IN MASTER MODE REGISTER
PROGRAM E1 SPECIFIC REGISTERS
PROGRAM T1 SPECIFIC REGISTERS
PROGRAM COMMON REGISTERS
DS2155 OPERATIONAL
39 of 238
DS2155
6.1 Power-Up Sequence
The DS2155 contains an on-chip power-up reset function that automatically clears the writeable register
space immediately after power is supplied to the DS2155. The user can issue a chip reset at any time.
Issuing a reset disrupts traffic flowing through the DS2155 until the device is reprogrammed. The reset
can be issued through hardware using the TSTRST pin or through software using the SFTRST function in
the master mode register. The LIRST (LIC2.6) should be toggled from 0 to 1 to reset the line interface
circuitry. (It takes the DS2155 about 40ms to recover from the LIRST bit being toggled.) Finally, after the
TSYSCLK and RSYSCLK inputs are stable, the receive and transmit elastic stores should be reset (this
step can be skipped if the elastic stores are disabled).
6.1.1 Master Mode Register
Register Name:
MSTRREG
Master Mode Register
00h
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
TEST1
0
2
TEST0
0
1
T1/E1
0
0
SFTRST
0
Bit 0/Software-Issued Reset (SFTRST). A 0-to-1 transition causes the register space in the DS2155 to be cleared.
A reset clears all configuration and status registers. The bit automatically clears itself when the reset has completed.
Bit 1/DS2155 Operating Mode (T1/E1). Used to select the operating mode of the framer/formatter (digital)
portion of the 2156. The operating mode of the LIU must also be programmed.
0 = T1 operation
1 = E1 operation
Bits 2, 3/Test Mode Bits (TEST0, TEST1). Test modes are used to force the output pins of the DS2155 into
known states. This can facilitate the checkout of assemblies during the manufacturing process and also be used to
isolate devices from shared buses.
TEST1 TEST0
Effect On Output Pins
0
0
Operate normally
0
1
1
1
0
1
Force all output pins into tri-state (including all I/O pins and parallel port pins)
Force all output pins low (including all I/O pins except parallel port pins)
Force all output pins high (including all I/O pins except parallel port pins)
Bits 4 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
40 of 238
DS2155
6.2 Interrupt Handling
Various alarms, conditions, and events in the DS2155 can cause interrupts. For simplicity, these are all
referred to as events in this explanation. All status registers can be programmed to produce interrupts.
Each status register has an associated interrupt mask register. For example, SR1 (status register 1) has an
interrupt control register called IMR1 (interrupt mask register 1). Status registers are the only sources of
interrupts in the DS2155. On power-up, all writeable registers are automatically cleared. Since bits in the
IMRx registers have to be set = 1 to allow a particular event to cause an interrupt, no interrupts can occur
until the host selects which events are to product interrupts. Since there are potentially many sources of
interrupts on the DS2155, several features are available to help sort out and identify which event is
causing an interrupt. When an interrupt occurs, the host should first read the IIR1 and IIR2 registers
(interrupt information registers) to identify which status register (or registers) is producing the interrupt.
Once that is determined, the individual status register or registers can be examined to determine the exact
source. In multiple port configurations, two to eight DS2155s can be connected together by the 3-wire
ESIB feature. This allows multiple DS2155s to be interrogated by a single CPU port read cycle. The host
can determine the synchronization status, or interrupt status of up to eight devices with a single read. The
ESIB feature also allows the user to select from various events to be examined through this method. For
more information, see Section 29.
Once an interrupt has occurred, the interrupt handler routine should set the INTDIS bit (CCR3.6) to stop
further activity on the interrupt pin. After all interrupts have been determined and processed, the interrupt
hander routine should re-enable interrupts by setting the INTDIS bit = 0.
6.3 Status Registers
When a particular event or condition has occurred (or is still occurring in the case of conditions), the
appropriate bit in a status register is set to a 1. All of the status registers operate in a latched fashion. This
means that if an event or condition occurs a bit is set to a 1. It remains set until the user reads that bit. An
event bit is cleared when it is read and it is not set again until the event has occurred again. Condition bits
such as RBL, RLOS, etc., remain set if the alarm is still present.
The user always proceeds a read of any of the status registers with a write. The byte written to the register
informs the DS2155 which bits the user wishes to read and have cleared. The user writes a byte to one of
these registers, with a 1 in the bit positions the user wishes to read and a 0 in the bit positions the user
does not wish to obtain the latest information on. When a 1 is written to a bit location, the read register is
updated with the latest information. When a 0 is written to a bit position, the read register is not updated
and the previous value is held. A write to the status registers is immediately followed by a read of the
same register. This write-read scheme allows an external microcontroller or microprocessor to
individually poll certain bits without disturbing the other bits in the register. This operation is key in
controlling the DS2155 with higher order languages.
Status register bits are divided into two groups, condition bits and event bits. Condition bits are typically
network conditions such as loss-of-sync or all-ones detect. Event bits are typically markers such as the
one-second timer, elastic store slip, etc. Each status register bit is labeled as a condition or event bit.
Some of the status registers have bits for both the detection of a condition and the clearance of the
condition. For example, SR2 has a bit that is set when the device goes into a loss-of-sync state (SR2.0, a
condition bit) and a bit that is set (SR2.4, an event bit) when the loss-of-sync condition clears (goes in
sync). Some of the status register bits (condition bits) do not have a separate bit for the “condition clear”
event but rather the status bit can produce interrupts on both edges, setting and clearing. These bits are
marked as double interrupt bits. An interrupt is produced when the condition occurs and when it clears.
41 of 238
DS2155
6.4 Information Registers
Information registers operate the same as status registers except they cannot cause interrupts. They are all
latched except for INFO7 and some of the bits in INFO5 and INFO6. INFO7 register is a read-only
register. It reports the status of the E1 synchronizer in real time. INFO7 and some of the bits in INFO6
and INFO5 are not latched and it is not necessary to precede a read of these bits with a write.
6.5 Interrupt Information Registers
The interrupt information registers provide an indication of which status registers (SR1 through SR9) are
generating an interrupt. When an interrupt occurs, the host can read IIR1 and IIR2 to quickly identify
which of the nine status registers are causing the interrupt.
Register Name:
IIR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Information Register 1
14h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
SR8
0
6
SR7
0
5
SR6
0
4
SR5
0
3
SR4
0
2
SR3
0
1
SR2
0
0
SR1
0
Register Name:
IIR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Information Register 2
15h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
U_RSR
0
0
SR9
0
42 of 238
DS2155
7. SPECIAL PER-CHANNEL REGISTER OPERATION
Some of the features described in the data sheet that operate on a per-channel basis use a special method
for channel selection. There are five registers involved: per-channel pointer register (PCPR) and per-
channel data registers 1–4 (PCDR1–4). The user selects which function or functions are to be applied on a
per-channel basis by setting the appropriate bit(s) in the PCPR register. The user then writes to the PCDR
registers to select the channels for that function. The following is an example of mapping the transmit and
receive BERT function to channels 9–12, 20, and 21.
Write 11h to PCPR
Write 00h to PCDR1
Write 0fh to PCDR2
Write 18h to PCDR3
Write 00h to PCDR4
The user may write to the PCDR1-4 with muliple functions in the PCPR register selected, but can only
read the values from the PCDR1-4 registers for a single function at a time. More information about how
to use these per-channel features can be found in their respective sections in the data sheet.
Register Name:
PCPR
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Pointer Register
28h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
BRCS
0
3
2
1
TFCS
0
0
BTCS
0
RSAOICS RSRCS RFCS
THSCS PEICS
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Bert Transmit Channel Select (BTCS)
Bit 1/Transmit Fractional Channel Select (TFCS)
Bit 2/Payload Error Insert Channel Select (PEICS)
Bit 3/Transmit Hardware Signaling Channel Select (THSCS)
Bit 4/Bert Receive Channel Select (BRCS)
Bit 5/Receive Fractional Channel Select (RFCS)
Bit 6/Receive Signaling Reinsertion Channel Select (RSRCS)
Bit 7/Receive Signaling All-Ones Insertion Channel Select (RSAOICS)
43 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
PCDR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Data Register 1
29h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
—
CH3
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH8
CH7
CH6
CH5
CH4
CH2
CH1
Register Name:
PCDR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Data Register 2
2Ah
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
—
CH11
1
—
CH10
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH16
CH15
CH14
CH13
CH12
CH9
Register Name:
PCDR3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Data Register 3
2Bh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
—
CH19
1
—
CH18
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH24
CH23
CH22
CH21
CH20
CH17
Register Name:
PCDR4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Data Register 4
2Ch
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
—
CH27
1
—
CH26
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH25
44 of 238
DS2155
8. CLOCK MAP
Figure 8-1 shows the clock map of the DS2155. The routing for the transmit and receive clocks are shown
for the various loopback modes and jitter attenuator positions. Although there is only one jitter attenuator,
which can be placed in the receive or transmit path, two are shown for simplification and clarity.
Figure 8-1. Clock Map
MCLK
TSYSCLK
MCLKS = 0
MCLKS = 1
LIC4.MPS0
PRE-SCALER
LIC4.MPS1
2.048 TO 1.544
SYNTHESIZER
LIC2.3
DJA = 1
DJA = 0
8 x PLL
8XCLK
LOCAL
JITTER ATTENUATOR
LOOPBACK
SEE LIC1 REGISTER
REMOTE
FRAMER
PAYLOAD
LOOPBACK
LOOPBACK
LOOPBACK
(SEE NOTES)
RCL = 1
JAS = 0
AND
BPCLK
SYNTH
LLB = 0
LLB = 1
BPCLK
RCLK
DJA = 0
FLB = 0
FLB = 1
LTCA
RXCLK
RECEIVE
FRAMER
RCL = 0
JAS = 1
OR
TO
JAS = 0
DJA = 1
LIU
OR
DJA = 1
RLB = 1
RLB = 0
PLB = 1
PLB = 0
TXCLK
LTCA
TRANSMIT
FORMATTER
JAS = 1
AND
DJA = 0
TCLK
MUX
A
B
C
TCLK
The TCLK MUX is dependent on the state of the TCSS0 and TCSS1 bits in the CCR1 register and the
state of the TCLK pin.
TCSS1
TCSS0
Transmit Clock Source
0
0
0
1
The TCLK pin (C) is always the source of transmit clock.
Switch to the recovered clock (B) when the signal at the TCLK pin
fails to transition after one channel time.
Use the scaled signal (A) derived from MCLK as the transmit clock.
The TCLK pin is ignored.
1
1
0
1
Use the recovered clock (B) as the transmit clock. The TCLK pin is
ignored.
45 of 238
DS2155
9. T1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS
The T1 framer portion of the DS2155 is configured through a set of nine control registers. Typically, the
control registers are only accessed when the system is first powered up. Once the DS2155 has been
initialized, the control registers only need to be accessed when there is a change in the system
configuration. There are two receive control registers (T1RCR1 and T1RCR2), two transmit control
registers (T1TCR1 and T1TCR2), and a common control register (T1CCR1). Each of these registers is
described in this section.
9.1 T1 Control Registers
Register Name:
T1RCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1 Receive Control Register 1
03h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
ARC
0
5
OOF1
0
4
OOF2
0
3
SYNCC
0
2
1
0
SYNCT SYNCE RESYNC
0
0
0
Bit 0/Resynchronize (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resynchronization of the receive-side framer
is initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resync.
Bit 1/Sync Enable (SYNCE)
0 = auto resync enabled
1 = auto resync disabled
Bit 2/Sync Time (SYNCT)
0 = qualify 10 bits
1 = qualify 24 bits
Bit 3/Sync Criteria (SYNCC)
In D4 Framing Mode:
0 = search for Ft pattern, then search for Fs pattern
1 = cross couple Ft and Fs pattern
In ESF Framing Mode:
0 = search for FPS pattern only
1 = search for FPS and verify with CRC6
Bits 4, 5/Out-of-Frame Select Bits (OOF2, OOF1)
OOF2
OOF1
Out-Of-Frame Criteria
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
2/4 frame bits in error
2/5 frame bits in error
2/6 frame bits in error
2/6 frame bits in error
Bit 6/Auto Resync Criteria (ARC)
0 = resync on OOF or RCL event
1 = resync on OOF only
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
46 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
T1RCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1 Receive Control Register 2
04h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
RFM
0
5
RB8ZS
0
4
RSLC96
0
3
RZSE
0
2
RZBTSI
0
1
RJC
0
0
RD4YM
0
Bit 0/Receive-Side D4 Yellow Alarm Select (RD4YM)
0 = 0s in bit 2 of all channels
1 = a 1 in the S-bit position of frame 12 (J1 Yellow Alarm Mode)
Bit 1/Receive Japanese CRC6 Enable (RJC)
0 = use ANSI/AT&T/ITU CRC6 calculation (normal operation)
1 = use Japanese standard JT–G704 CRC6 calculation
Bit 2/Receive-Side ZBTSI Support Enable (RZBTSI). Allows ZBTSI information to be output on RLINK pin.
0 = ZBTSI disabled
1 = ZBTSI enabled
Bit 3/Receive FDL Zero-Destuffer Enable (RZSE). Set this bit to 0 if using the internal HDLC/BOC controller
instead of the legacy support for the FDL. See Section 23.5 for details.
0 = zero destuffer disabled
1 = zero destuffer enabled
Bit 4/Receive SLC-96 Enable (RSLC96). Only set this bit to a 1 in D4/SLC-96 framing applications. See Section
23.6 for details.
0 = SLC-96 disabled
1 = SLC-96 enabled
Bit 5/Receive B8ZS Enable (RB8ZS)
0 = B8ZS disabled
1 = B8ZS enabled
Bit 6/Receive Frame Mode Select (RFM)
0 = D4 framing mode
1 = ESF framing mode
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
47 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
T1TCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1 Transmit Control Register 1
05h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TJC
0
6
TFPT
0
5
TCPT
0
4
TSSE
0
3
GB7S
0
2
TFDLS
0
1
TBL
0
0
TYEL
0
Bit 0/Transmit Yellow Alarm (TYEL)
0 = do not transmit yellow alarm
1 = transmit yellow alarm
Bit 1/Transmit Blue Alarm (TBL)
0 = transmit data normally
1 = transmit an unframed all-ones code at TPOS and TNEG
Bit 2/TFDL Register Select (TFDLS)
0 = source FDL or Fs-bits from the internal TFDL register (legacy FDL support mode)
1 = source FDL or Fs-bits from the internal HDLC controller or the TLINK pin
Bit 3/Global Bit 7 Stuffing (GB7S)
0 = allow the SSIEx registers to determine which channels containing all 0s are to be bit 7 stuffed
1 = force bit 7 stuffing in all 0-byte channels regardless of how the SSIEx registers are programmed
Bit 4/Transmit Software Signaling Enable (TSSE).
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers regardless of the SSIEx registers. The SSIEx
registers still define which channels are to have B7 stuffing preformed.
1 = source signaling data as enabled by the SSIEx registers
Bit 5/Transmit CRC Pass-Through (TCPT)
0 = source CRC6 bits internally
1 = CRC6 bits sampled at TSER during F-bit time
Bit 6/Transmit F-Bit Pass-Through (TFPT)
0 = F bits sourced internally
1 = F bits sampled at TSER
Bit 7/Transmit Japanese CRC6 Enable (TJC)
0 = use ANSI/AT&T/ITU CRC6 calculation (normal operation)
1 = use Japanese standard JT–G704 CRC6 calculation
48 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
T1TCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1 Transmit Control Register 2
06h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
TZSE
0
4
3
2
1
0
TB8ZS TSLC96
FBCT2 FBCT1 TD4YM TZBTSI TB7ZS
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit-Side Bit 7 Zero-Suppression Enable (TB7ZS)
0 = no stuffing occurs
1 = bit 7 forced to a 1 in channels with all 0s
Bit 1/Transmit-Side ZBTSI Support Enable (TZBTSI). Allows ZBTSI information to be input on TLINK pin.
0 = ZBTSI disabled
1 = ZBTSI enabled
Bit 2/Transmit-Side D4 Yellow Alarm Select (TD4YM)
0 = 0s in bit 2 of all channels
1 = a 1 in the S-bit position of frame 12
Bit 3/F-Bit Corruption Type 1 (FBCT1). A low-to-high transition of this bit causes the next three consecutive Ft
(D4 framing mode) or FPS (ESF framing mode) bits to be corrupted causing the remote end to experience a loss of
synchronization.
Bit 4/F-Bit Corruption Type 2 (FBCT2). Setting this bit high enables the corruption of one Ft (D4 framing mode)
or FPS (ESF framing mode) bit in every 128 Ft or FPS bits as long as the bit remains set.
Bit 5/Transmit FDL Zero-Stuffer Enable (TZSE). Set this bit to 0 if using the internal HDLC controller instead
of the legacy support for the FDL. See Section 15 for details.
0 = zero stuffer disabled
1 = zero stuffer enabled
Bit 6/Transmit SLC-96/Fs-Bit Insertion Enable (TSLC96). Only set this bit to a 1 in D4 framing applications.
Must be set to 1 to source the Fs pattern from the TFDL register. See Section 23.6 for details.
0 = SLC-96/Fs-bit insertion disabled
1 = SLC-96/Fs-bit insertion enabled
Bit 7/Transmit B8ZS Enable (TB8ZS)
0 = B8ZS disabled
1 = B8ZS enabled
49 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
T1CCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1 Common Control Register 1
07h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
3
2
TFM
0
1
PDE
0
0
TLOOP
0
TRAI-CI TAIS-CI
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit Loop-Code Enable (TLOOP). See Section 25 for details.
0 = transmit data normally
1 = replace normal transmitted data with repeating code as defined in registers TCD1 and TCD2
Bit 1/Pulse Density Enforcer Enable (PDE). The framer always examines the transmit and receive data streams
for violations of these, which are required by ANSI T1.403: No more than 15 consecutive 0s and at least N 1s in
each and every time window of 8 x (N + 1) bits, where N = 1 through 23. Violations for the transmit and receive
data streams are reported in the INFO1.6 and INFO1.7 bits, respectively. When this bit is set to 1, the DS2155
forces the transmitted stream to meet this requirement no matter the content of the transmitted stream. When
running B8ZS, this bit should be set to 0 since B8ZS encoded data streams cannot violate the pulse density
requirements.
0 = disable transmit pulse density enforcer
1 = enable transmit pulse density enforcer
Bit 2/Transmit Frame Mode Select (TFM)
0 = D4 framing mode
1 = ESF framing mode
Bit 3/Transmit AIS-CI Enable (TAIS-CI). Setting this bit and the TBL bit (T1TCR1.1) causes the AIS-CI code
to be transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO, as defined in ANSI T1.403.
0 = do not transmit the AIS-CI code
1 = transmit the AIS-CI code (T1TCR1.1 must also be set = 1)
Bit 4/Transmit RAI-CI Enable (TRAI-CI). Setting this bit causes the ESF RAI-CI code to be transmitted in the
FDL bit position.
0 = do not transmit the ESF RAI-CI code
1 = transmit the ESF RAI-CI code
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
50 of 238
DS2155
9.2 T1 Transmit Transparency
The software signaling insertion-enable registers, SSIE1–SSIE4, can be used to select signaling insertion
from the transmit signaling registers, TS1–TS12, on a per-channel basis. Setting a bit in the SSIEx
register allows signaling data to be sourced from the signaling registers for that channel.
In transparent mode, bit 7 stuffing and/or robbed-bit signaling is prevented from overwriting the data in
the channels. If a DS0 is programmed to be clear, no robbed-bit signaling is inserted nor does the channel
have bit 7 stuffing performed. However, in the D4 framing mode, bit 2 is overwritten by a 0 when a
Yellow Alarm is transmitted. Also, the user has the option to globally override the SSIEx registers from
determining which channels are to have bit 7 stuffing performed. If the T1TCR1.3 and T1TCR2.0 bits are
set to 1, then all 24 T1 channels have bit 7 stuffing performed on them, regardless of how the SSIEx
registers are programmed. In this manner, the SSIEx registers are only affecting the channels that are to
have robbed-bit signaling inserted into them.
9.3 AIS-CI and RAI-CI Generation and Detection
The DS2155 can transmit and detect the RAI-CI and AIS-CI codes in T1 mode. These codes are
compatible with and do not interfere with the standard RAI (Yellow) and AIS (Blue) alarms. These codes
are defined in ANSI T1.403.
The AIS-CI code (alarm indication signal-customer installation) is the same for both ESF and D4
operation. Setting the TAIS-CI bit in the T1CCR1 register and the TBL bit in the T1TCR1 register causes
the DS2155 to transmit the AIS-CI code. The RAIS-CI status bit in the SR4 register indicates the
reception of an AIS-CI signal.
The RAI-CI (remote alarm indication-customer installation) code for T1 ESF operation is a special form
of the ESF Yellow Alarm (an unscheduled message). Setting the RAIS-CI bit in the T1CCR1 register
causes the DS2155 to transmit the RAI-CI code. The RAI-CI code causes a standard Yellow Alarm to be
detected by the receiver. When the host processor detects a Yellow Alarm, it can then test the alarm for
the RAI-CI state by checking the BOC detector for the RAI-CI flag. That flag is a 011111 code in the 6-
bit BOC message.
The RAI-CI code for T1 D4 operation is a 10001011 flag in all 24 time slots. To transmit the RAI-CI
code the host sets all 24 channels to idle with a 10001011 idle code. Since this code meets the
requirements for a standard T1 D4 Yellow Alarm, the host can use the receive channel monitor function
to detect the 100001011 code whenever a standard Yellow Alarm is detected.
51 of 238
DS2155
9.4 T1 Receive-Side Digital-Milliwatt Code Generation
Receive-side digital-milliwatt code generation involves using the receive digital-milliwatt registers
(T1RDMR1/2/3) to determine which of the 24 T1 channels of the T1 line going to the backplane should
be overwritten with a digital-milliwatt pattern. The digital-milliwatt code is an 8-byte repeating pattern
that represents a 1kHz sine wave (1E/0B/0B/1E/9E/8B/8B/9E). Each bit in the T1RDMRx registers
represents a particular channel. If a bit is set to a 1, then the receive data in that channel is replaced with
the digital-milliwatt code. If a bit is set to 0, no replacement occurs.
Register Name:
T1RDMR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 1
0Ch
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH8
0
6
CH7
0
5
CH6
0
4
CH5
0
3
CH4
0
2
CH3
0
1
CH2
0
0
CH1
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable for Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8)
0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel
1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code
Register Name:
T1RDMR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 2
0Dh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH16
0
6
CH15
0
5
CH14
0
4
CH13
0
3
CH12
0
2
CH11
0
1
CH10
0
0
CH9
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16)
0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel
1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code
Register Name:
T1RDMR3
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 3
0Eh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH24
0
6
CH23
0
5
CH22
0
4
CH21
0
3
CH20
0
2
CH19
0
1
CH18
0
0
CH17
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable for Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24)
0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel
1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code
52 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
INFO1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Information Register 1
10h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RPDV
0
6
TPDV
0
5
COFA
0
4
8ZD
0
3
16ZD
0
2
SEFE
0
1
B8ZS
0
0
FBE
0
Bit 0/Frame Bit-Error Event (FBE). Set when an Ft (D4) or FPS (ESF) framing bit is received in error.
Bit 1/B8ZS Codeword Detect Event (B8ZS). Set when a B8ZS codeword is detected at RPOS and RNEG
independent of whether the B8ZS mode is selected or not by T1TCR2.7. Useful for automatically setting the line
coding.
Bit 2/Severely Errored Framing Event (SEFE). Set when two out of six framing bits (Ft or FPS) are received in
error.
Bit 3/Sixteen Zero-Detect Event (16ZD). Set when a string of at least 16 consecutive 0s (regardless of the length
of the string) have been received at RPOSI and RNEGI.
Bit 4/Eight Zero-Detect Event (8ZD). Set when a string of at least eight consecutive 0s (regardless of the length
of the string) have been received at RPOSI and RNEGI.
Bit 5/Change-of-Frame Alignment Event (COFA). Set when the last resync resulted in a change-of-frame or
multiframe alignment.
Bit 6/Transmit Pulse-Density Violation Event (TPDV). Set when the transmit data stream does not meet the
ANSI T1.403 requirements for pulse density.
Bit 7/Receive Pulse-Density Violation Event (RPDV). Set when the receive data stream does not meet the ANSI
T1.403 requirements for pulse density.
53 of 238
DS2155
Table 9-A. T1 Alarm Criteria
ALARM
SET CRITERIA
CLEAR CRITERIA
Blue Alarm (AIS)
When over a 3ms window, five or
When over a 3ms window, six or
(Note 1)
fewer 0s are received
more 0s are received
Yellow Alarm (RAI)
D4 Bit 2 Mode
(T1RCR2.0 = 0)
When bit 2 of 256 consecutive
channels is set to 0 for at least 254
occurrences
When bit 2 of 256 consecutive
channels is set to 0 for fewer than
254 occurrences
D4 12th F-Bit Mode
When the 12th framing bit is set to 1 When the 12th framing bit is set to
(T1RCR2.0 = 1; this mode is also
referred to as the “Japanese Yellow
Alarm”)
for two consecutive occurrences
0 for two consecutive occurrences
ESF Mode
When 16 consecutive patterns of
00FF appear in the FDL
When 14 or fewer patterns of 00FF
hex out of 16 possible appear in the
FDL
Red Alarm (LRCL)
When 192 consecutive 0s are
received
When 14 or more 1s out of 112
possible bit positions are received
(Also referred to as loss of signal)
Note 1: The definition of Blue Alarm (or AIS) is an unframed all-ones signal. Blue Alarm detectors should be able to operate properly in the
presence of a 10E-3 error rate and they should not falsely trigger on a framed all-1s signal. Blue Alarm criteria in the DS2155 has been
set to achieve this performance. It is recommended that the RBL bit be qualified with the RLOS bit.
Note 2: ANSI specifications use a different nomenclature than the DS2155 does. The following terms are equivalent:
RBL = AIS
RCL = LOS
RLOS = LOF
RYEL = RAI
54 of 238
DS2155
10. E1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS
The E1 framer portion of the DS2155 is configured by a set of four control registers. Typically, the
control registers are only accessed when the system is first powered up. Once the DS2155 has been
initialized, the control registers need only to be accessed when there is a change in the system
configuration. There are two receive control registers (E1RCR1 and E1RCR2) and two transmit control
registers (E1TCR1 and E1TCR2). There are also four status and information registers. Each of these eight
registers is described in this section.
10.1E1 Control Registers
Register Name:
E1RCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
E1 Receive Control Register 1
33h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
FRC
0
1
0
RSERC RSIGM RHDB3 RG802 RCRC4
SYNCE RESYNC
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Resync (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resync is initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a
subsequent resync.
Bit 1/Sync Enable (SYNCE)
0 = auto resync enabled
1 = auto resync disabled
Bit 2/Frame Resync Criteria (FRC)
0 = resync if FAS received in error three consecutive times
1 = resync if FAS or bit 2 of non-FAS is received in error three consecutive times
Bit 3/Receive CRC4 Enable (RCRC4)
0 = CRC4 disabled
1 = CRC4 enabled
Bit 4/Receive G.802 Enable (RG802). See Section 17 for details.
0 = do not force RCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26
1 = force RCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26
Bit 5/Receive HDB3 Enable (RHDB3)
0 = HDB3 disabled
1 = HDB3 enabled
Bit 6/Receive Signaling Mode Select (RSIGM)
0 = CAS signaling mode
1 = CCS signaling mode
Bit 7/RSER Control (RSERC)
0 = allow RSER to output data as received under all conditions
1 = force RSER to 1 under loss-of-frame alignment conditions
55 of 238
DS2155
Table 10-A. E1 Sync/Resync Criteria
FRAME OR
MULTIFRAME
LEVEL
SYNC CRITERIA
RESYNC CRITERIA
ITU SPEC.
Three consecutive incorrect
FAS received
FAS present in frame N and
N + 2; FAS not present in
frame N + 1
G.706
4.1.1
4.1.2
FAS
Alternate: (E1RCR1.2 = 1) The
above criteria is met or three
consecutive incorrect bit 2 of
non-FAS received
915 or more CRC4 codewords
out of 1000 received in error
Two valid MF alignment
words found within 8ms
Valid MF alignment word
found and previous time slot
16 contains code other than
all 0s
G.706
CRC4
CAS
4.2 and 4.3.2
Two consecutive MF
alignment words received in
error
G.732
5.2
Register Name:
E1RCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
E1 Receive Control Register 2
34h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Sa8S
0
6
Sa7S
0
5
Sa6S
0
4
Sa5S
0
3
Sa4S
0
2
—
0
1
—
0
0
RCLA
0
Bit 0/Receive Carrier-Loss (RCL) Alternate Criteria (RCLA). Defines the criteria for a receive carrier-loss
condition for both the framer and LIU.
0 = RCL declared upon 255 consecutive 0s (125µs)
1 = RCL declared upon 2048 consecutive 0s (1ms)
Bits 1, 2/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Bit 3/Sa4 Bit Select (Sa4S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa4 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low
during Sa4 bit position. See Section 35 for details.
Bit 4/Sa5 Bit Select (Sa5S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa5 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low
during Sa5 bit position. See Section 35 for details.
Bit 5/Sa6 Bit Select (Sa6S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa6 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low
during Sa6 bit position. See Section 35 for details.
Bit 6/Sa7 Bit Select (Sa7S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa7 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low
during Sa7 bit position. See Section 35 for details.
Bit 7/Sa8 Bit Select (Sa8S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa8 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low
during Sa8 bit position. See Section 35 for details.
56 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
E1TCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
E1 Transmit Control Register 1
35h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TFPT
0
6
T16S
0
5
TUA1
0
4
TSiS
0
3
TSA1
0
2
1
0
TCRC4
0
THDB3 TG802
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit CRC4 Enable (TCRC4)
0 = CRC4 disabled
1 = CRC4 enabled
Bit 1/Transmit G.802 Enable (TG802). See Section 35 for details.
0 = do not force TCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26
1 = force TCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26
Bit 2/Transmit HDB3 Enable (THDB3)
0 = HDB3 disabled
1 = HDB3 enabled
Bit 3/Transmit Signaling All Ones (TSA1)
0 = normal operation
1 = force time slot 16 in every frame to all ones
Bit 4/Transmit International Bit Select (TSiS)
0 = sample Si bits at TSER pin
1 = source Si bits from TAF and TNAF registers (in this mode, E1TCR1.7 must be set to 0)
Bit 5/Transmit Unframed All Ones (TUA1)
0 = transmit data normally
1 = transmit an unframed all-ones code at TPOSO and TNEGO
Bit 6/Transmit Time Slot 16 Data Select (T16S). See Section 16.2 for details.
0 = time slot 16 determined by the SSIEx registers and the THSCS function in the PCPR register
1 = source time slot 16 from TS1 to TS16 registers
Bit 7/Transmit Time Slot 0 Pass-Through (TFPT)
0 = FAS bits/Sa bits/remote alarm sourced internally from the TAF and TNAF registers
1 = FAS bits/Sa bits/remote alarm sourced from TSER
57 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
E1TCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
E1 Transmit Control Register 2
36h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Sa8S
0
6
Sa7S
0
5
Sa6S
0
4
Sa5S
0
3
Sa4S
0
2
AEBE
0
1
AAIS
0
0
ARA
0
Bit 0/Automatic Remote Alarm Generation (ARA)
0 = disabled
1 = enabled
Bit 1/Automatic AIS Generation (AAIS)
0 = disabled
1 = enabled
Bit 2/Automatic E-Bit Enable (AEBE)
0 = E-bits not automatically set in the transmit direction
1 = E-bits automatically set in the transmit direction
Bit 3/Sa4 Bit Select (Sa4S). Set to 1 to source the Sa4 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa4 bit.
See Section 35 for details.
Bit 4/Sa5 Bit Select (Sa5S). Set to 1 to source the Sa5 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa5 bit.
See Section 35 for details.
Bit 5/Sa6 Bit Select (Sa6S). Set to 1 to source the Sa6 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa6 bit.
See Section 35 for details.
Bit 6/Sa7 Bit Select (Sa7S). Set to 1 to source the Sa7 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa7 bit.
See Section 35 for details.
Bit 7/Sa8 Bit Select (Sa8S). Set to 1 to source the Sa8 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa8 bit.
See Section 35 for details.
58 of 238
DS2155
10.2Automatic Alarm Generation
The device can be programmed to automatically transmit AIS or remote alarm. When automatic AIS
generation is enabled (E1TCR2.1 = 1), the device monitors the receive-side framer to determine if any of
the following conditions are present: loss-of-receive frame synchronization, AIS alarm (all ones)
reception, or loss-of-receive carrier (or signal). The framer forces either an AIS or remote alarm if any
one or more of these conditions is present.
When automatic RAI generation is enabled (E1TCR2.0 = 1), the framer monitors the receive side to
determine if any of the following conditions are present: loss-of-receive-frame synchronization, AIS
alarm (all ones) reception, loss-of-receive carrier (or signal), or if CRC4 multiframe synchronization
cannot be found within 128ms of FAS synchronization (if CRC4 is enabled). If any one or more of these
conditions is present, then the framer transmits an RAI alarm. RAI generation conforms to ETS 300 011
specifications and a constant remote alarm is transmitted if the DS2155 cannot find CRC4 multiframe
synchronization within 400ms as per G.706.
Note: It is an invalid state to have both automatic AIS generation and automatic remote alarm generation
enabled at the same time.
59 of 238
DS2155
10.3E1 Information Registers
Register Name:
INFO3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Information Register 3
12h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
1
0
CRCRC FASRC CASRC
0
0
0
Bit 0/CAS Resync Criteria Met Event (CASRC). Set when two consecutive CAS MF alignment words are
received in error.
Bit 1/FAS Resync Criteria Met Event (FASRC). Set when three consecutive FAS words are received in error.
Note: During a CRC resync the FAS synchronizer is brought online to verify the FAS alignment. If during this
process an FAS emulator exists, the FAS synchronizer may temporarily align to the emulator. The FASRC will go
active indicating a search for a valid FAS has been activated.
Bit 2/CRC Resync Criteria Met Event (CRCRC). Set when 915/1000 codewords are received in error.
Register Name:
INFO7
Register Description:
Register Address:
Information Register 7 (Real-Time, Non-Latched Register)
30h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CSC5
0
6
CSC4
0
5
CSC3
0
4
CSC2
0
3
CSC0
0
2
1
0
FASSA CASSA CRC4SA
0
0
0
Bit 0/CRC4 MF Sync Active (CRC4SA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for the CRC4 MF alignment
word. This is a read-only, non-latched, real-time bit. It is not necessary to precede the read of this bit with a write.
Bit 1/CAS MF Sync Active (CASSA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for the CAS MF alignment word.
This is a read-only, non-latched, real-time bit. It is not necessary to precede the read of this bit with a write.
Bit 2/FAS Sync Active (FASSA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for alignment at the FAS level. This is a
read-only, non-latched, real-time bit. It is not necessary to precede the read of this bit with a write.
Bits 3 to 7/CRC4 Sync Counter Bits (CSC0, CSC2 to CSC4). The CRC4 sync counter increments each time the
8ms CRC4 multiframe search times out. The counter is cleared when the framer has successfully obtained
synchronization at the CRC4 level. The counter can also be cleared by disabling the CRC4 mode (E1RCR1.3 = 0).
This counter is useful for determining the amount of time the framer has been searching for synchronization at the
CRC4 level. ITU G.706 suggests that if synchronization at the CRC4 level cannot be obtained within 400ms, then
the search should be abandoned and proper action taken. The CRC4 sync counter rolls over. CSC0 is the LSB of
the 6-bit counter. (Note: The bit next to LSB is not accessible. CSC1 is omitted to allow resolution to >400ms
using 5 bits.) These are read-only, non-latched, real-time bits. It is not necessary to precede the read of these bits
with a write.
60 of 238
DS2155
Table 10-B. E1 Alarm Criteria
ITU
ALARM
SET CRITERIA
CLEAR CRITERIA
SPECIFICATION
An RLOS condition exists on power-up
prior to initial synchronization, when a
resync criteria has been met, or when a
manual resync has been initiated by
E1RCR1.0
RLOS
RCL
255 or 2048 consecutive 0s received as
determined by E1RCR2.0
At least 32 1s in 255-bit times
are received
G.775/G.962
Bit 3 of nonalign frame set to
0 for three consecutive
occasions
Bit 3 of nonalign frame set to 1 for three
consecutive occasions
O.162
2.1.4
RRA
Fewer than three 0s in two frames (512
bits)
Bit 6 of time slot 16 in frame 0 has been set
for two consecutive multiframes
More than two 0s in two
frames (512 bits)
O.162
RUA1
1.6.1.2
RDMA
V52LNK Two out of three Sa7 bits are 0
G.965
61 of 238
DS2155
11. COMMON CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS
Register Name:
CCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Common Control Register 1
70h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
SIE
0
4
ODM
0
3
DICAI
0
2
TCSS1
0
1
TCSS0
0
0
RLOSF
0
MCLKS CRC4R
0
0
Bit 0/Function of the RLOS/LOTC Output (RLOSF)
0 = receive loss of sync (RLOS)
1 = loss-of-transmit clock (LOTC)
Bit 1/Transmit Clock Source Select Bit 0 (TCSS0)
Bit 2/Transmit Clock Source Select Bit 0 (TCSS1)
TCSS1
TCSS0
Transmit Clock Source
0
0
The TCLK pin is always the source of transmit clock.
Switch to the clock present at RCLK when the signal at the TCLK pin
0
1
1
1
0
1
fails to transition after 1 channel time.
Use the scaled signal present at MCLK as the transmit clock. The
TCLK pin is ignored.
Use the signal present at RCLK as the transmit clock. The TCLK pin is
ignored.
Bit 3/Disable Idle Code Auto Increment (DICAI). Selects/deselects the auto-increment feature for the transmit
and receive idle code array address register. See Section 17.
0 = addresses in IAAR register automatically increment on every read/write operation to the PCICR
register
1 = addresses in IAAR register do not automatically increment
Bit 4/Output Data Mode (ODM)
0 = pulses at TPOSO and TNEGO are one full TCLKO period wide
1 = pulses at TPOSO and TNEGO are one-half TCLKO period wide
Bit 5/Signaling Integration Enable (SIE)
0 = signaling changes of state reported on any change in selected channels
1 = signaling must be stable for three multiframes in order for a change of state to be reported
Bit 6/CRC-4 Recalculate (CRC4R)
0 = transmit CRC-4 generation and insertion operates in normal mode
1 = transmit CRC-4 generation operates according to G.706 intermediate path recalculation method
Bit 7/MCLK Source (MCLKS). Selects the source of MCLK
0 = MCLK is source from the MCLK pin
1 = MCLK is source from the TSYSCLK pin
62 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IDR
Register Description:
Register Address:
Device Identification Register
0Fh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
ID7
1
6
ID6
0
5
ID5
1
4
ID4
1
3
ID3
X
2
ID2
X
1
ID1
X
0
ID0
X
Bits 0 to 3/Chip Revision Bits (ID0 to ID3). The lower four bits of the IDR are used to display the die revision of
the chip. IDO is the LSB of a decimal code that represents the chip revision.
Bits 4 to 7/Device ID (ID4 to ID7). The upper four bits of the IDR are used to display the DS2155 ID.
11.1T1/E1 Status Registers
Register Name:
SR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Status Register 2
18h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
RUA1
0
1
FRCL
0
0
RLOS
0
RYELC RUA1C FRCLC RLOSC RYEL
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Loss-of-Sync Condition (RLOS). Set when the DS2155 is not synchronized to the received data
stream.
Bit 1/Framer Receive Carrier-Loss Condition (FRCL). Set when 255 (or 2048 if E1RCR2.0 = 1) E1 mode or
192 T1 mode consecutive 0s have been detected at RPOSI and RNEGI.
Bit 2/Receive Unframed All-Ones (T1 Blue Alarm, E1 AIS) Condition (RUA1). Set when an unframed all 1s
code is received at RPOSI and RNEGI.
Bit 3/Receive Yellow Alarm Condition (RYEL) (T1 Only). Set when a Yellow Alarm is received at RPOSI and
RNEGI.
Bit 4/Receive Loss-of-Sync Clear Event (RLOSC). Set when the framer achieves synchronization; remains set
until read.
Bit 5/Framer Receive Carrier-Loss Clear Event (FRCLC). Set when the carrier loss condition at RPOSI and
RNEGI is no longer detected.
Bit 6/Receive Unframed All-Ones Clear Event (RUA1C). Set when the unframed all 1s condition is no longer
detected.
Bit 7/Receive Yellow Alarm Clear Event (RYELC) (T1 Only). Set when the receive Yellow Alarm condition is
no longer detected.
63 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IMR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Mask Register 2
19h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
RYEL
0
2
RUA1
0
1
FRCL
0
0
RLOS
0
RYELC RUA1C FRCLC RLOSC
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Loss-of-Sync Condition (RLOS)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only
Bit 1/Framer Receive Carrier Loss Condition (FRCL)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only
Bit 2/Receive Unframed All-Ones (Blue Alarm) Condition (RUA1)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only
Bit 3/Receive Yellow Alarm Condition (RYEL)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only
Bit 4/Receive Loss-of-Sync Clear Event (RLOSC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 5/Framer Receive Carrier Loss Condition Clear (FRCLC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 6/Receive Unframed All-Ones Condition Clear Event (RUA1C)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 7/Receive Yellow Alarm Clear Event (RYELC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
64 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SR3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Status Register 3
1Ah
Bit #
Name
Default
7
LSPARE
0
6
LDN
0
5
LUP
0
4
LOTC
0
3
LORC
0
2
1
0
RRA
0
V52LNK RDMA
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Remote Alarm Condition (RRA) (E1 Only). Set when a remote alarm is received at RPOSI and
RNEGI. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.
Bit 1/Receive Distant MF Alarm Condition (RDMA) (E1 Only). Set when bit 6 of time slot 16 in frame 0 has
been set for two consecutive multiframes. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode. This is a double
interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.
Bit 2/V5.2 Link Detected Condition (V52LNK) (E1 Only). Set on detection of a V5.2 link identification signal
(G.965). This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.
Bit 3/Loss-of-Receive Clock Condition (LORC). Set when the RCLKI pin has not transitioned for one channel
time. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.
Bit 4/Loss-of-Transmit Clock Condition (LOTC). Set when the TCLK pin has not transitioned for one channel
time. Forces the LOTC pin high if enabled by CCR1.0. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.
Bit 5/Loop-Up Code Detected Condition (LUP) (T1 Only). Set when the loop-up code as defined in the
RUPCD1/2 register is being received. See Section 25 for details. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.
Bit 6/Loop-Down Code Detected Condition (LDN) (T1 Only). Set when the loop down code as defined in the
RDNCD1/2 register is being received. See Section 25 for details. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.
Bit 7/Spare Code Detected Condition (LSPARE) (T1 Only). Set when the spare code as defined in the RSCD1/2
registers is being received. See Section 25 for details. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.
65 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IMR3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Mask Register 3
1Bh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
LSPARE
0
6
LDN
0
5
LUP
0
4
LOTC
0
3
LORC
0
2
1
0
RRA
0
V52LNK RDMA
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Remote Alarm Condition (RRA)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 1/Receive Distant MF Alarm Condition (RDMA)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 2/V5.2 Link Detected Condition (V52LNK)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 3/Loss-of-Receive Clock Condition (LORC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 4/Loss-of-Transmit Clock Condition (LOTC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 5/Loop-Up Code-Detected Condition (LUP)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 6/Loop-Down Code-Detected Condition (LDN)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 7/Spare Code Detected Condition (LSPARE)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
66 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SR4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Status Register 4
1Ch
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
RSAZ
0
4
TMF
0
3
TAF
0
2
RMF
0
1
RCMF
0
0
RAF
0
RAIS-CI RSAO
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Align Frame Event (RAF) (E1 Only). Set every 250µs at the beginning of align frames. Used to
alert the host that Si and Sa bits are available in the RAF and RNAF registers.
Bit 1/Receive CRC4 Multiframe Event (RCMF) (E1 Only). Set on CRC4 multiframe boundaries; continues to
set every 2ms on an arbitrary boundary if CRC4 is disabled.
Bit 2/Receive Multiframe Event (RMF)
E1 Mode: Set every 2ms (regardless if CAS signaling is enabled or not) on receive multiframe boundaries.
Used to alert the host that signaling data is available.
T1 Mode: Set every 1.5ms on D4 MF boundaries or every 3ms on ESF MF boundaries.
Bit 3/Transmit Align Frame Event (TAF) (E1 Only). Set every 250µs at the beginning of align frames. Used to
alert the host that the TAF and TNAF registers need to be updated.
Bit 4/Transmit Multiframe Event (TMF)
E1 Mode: Set every 2ms (regardless if CRC4 is enabled) on transmit multiframe boundaries. Used to alert
the host that signaling data needs to be updated.
T1 Mode: Set every 1.5ms on D4 MF boundaries or every 3ms on ESF MF boundaries.
Bit 5/Receive Signaling All-Zeros Event (RSAZ) (E1 Only). Set when over a full MF, time slot 16 contains
all 0s.
Bit 6/Receive Signaling All-Ones Event (RSAO) (E1 Only). Set when the contents of time slot 16 contains fewer
than three 0s over 16 consecutive frames. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode.
Bit 7/Receive AIS-CI Event (RAIS-CI) (T1 Only). Set when the receiver detects the AIS-CI pattern as defined in
ANSI T1.403.
67 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IMR4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Mask Register 4
1Dh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
RSAZ
0
4
TMF
0
3
TAF
0
2
RMF
0
1
RCMF
0
0
RAF
0
RAIS-CI RSAO
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Align Frame Event (RAF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 1/Receive CRC4 Multiframe Event (RCMF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 2/Receive Multiframe Event (RMF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 3/Transmit Align Frame Event (TAF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 4/Transmit Multiframe Event (TMF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 5/Receive Signaling All-Zeros Event (RSAZ)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 6/Receive Signaling All-Ones Event (RSAO)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 7/Receive AIS-CI Event (RAIS-CI)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
68 of 238
DS2155
12. I/O PIN CONFIGURATION OPTIONS
Register Name:
IOCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
I/O Configuration Register 1
01h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSMS
0
6
5
4
RSIO
0
3
TSDW
0
2
TSM
0
1
TSIO
0
0
ODF
0
RSMS2 RSMS1
0
0
Bit 0/Output Data Format (ODF)
0 = bipolar data at TPOSO and TNEGO
1 = NRZ data at TPOSO; TNEGO = 0
Bit 1/TSYNC I/O Select (TSIO)
0 = TSYNC is an input
1 = TSYNC is an output
Bit 2/TSYNC Mode Select (TSM). Selects frame or multiframe mode for the TSYNC pin. See the timing
diagrams in Section 35.
0 = frame mode
1 = multiframe mode
Bit 3/TSYNC Double-Wide (TSDW). (Note: This bit must be set to 0 when IOCR1.2 = 1 or when IOCR1.1 = 0.)
0 = do not pulse double-wide in signaling frames
1 = do pulse double-wide in signaling frames
Bit 4/RSYNC I/O Select (RSIO). (Note: This bit must be set to 0 when ESCR.0 = 0.)
0 = RSYNC is an output
1 = RSYNC is an input (only valid if elastic store enabled)
Bit 5/RSYNC Mode Select 1(RSMS1). Selects frame or multiframe pulse when RSYNC pin is in output mode. In
input mode (elastic store must be enabled), multiframe mode is only useful when receive signaling reinsertion is
enabled. See the timing diagrams in Section 35.
0 = frame mode
1 = multiframe mode
Bit 6/RSYNC Mode Select 2 (RSMS2)
T1 Mode: RSYNC pin must be programmed in the output frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0, IOCR1.4 = 0).
0 = do not pulse double-wide in signaling frames
1 = do pulse double-wide in signaling frames
E1 Mode: RSYNC pin must be programmed in the output multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1, IOCR1.4 = 0).
0 = RSYNC outputs CAS multiframe boundaries
1 = RSYNC outputs CRC4 multiframe boundaries
Bit 7/RSYNC Multiframe Skip Control (RSMS). Useful in framing format conversions from D4 to ESF. This
function is not available when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. RSYNC must be set to output multiframe
pulses (IOCR1.5 = 1 and IOCR1.4 = 0).
0 = RSYNC outputs a pulse at every multiframe
1 = RSYNC outputs a pulse at every other multiframe
69 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IOCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
I/O Configuration Register 2
02h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RCLKINV TCLKINV RSYNCINV TSYNCINV TSSYNCINV H100EN TSCLKM RSCLKM
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/RSYSCLK Mode Select (RSCLKM)
0 = if RSYSCLK is 1.544MHz
1 = if RSYSCLK is 2.048MHz or IBO enabled (See Section 28 for details on IBO function.)
Bit 1/TSYSCLK Mode Select (TSCLKM)
0 = if TSYSCLK is 1.544MHz
1 = if TSYSCLK is 2.048MHz or IBO enabled (See Section 28 for details on IBO function.)
Bit 2/H.100 SYNC Mode (H100EN)
0 = normal operation
1 = SYNC shift
Bit 3/TSSYNC Invert (TSSYNCINV)
0 = no inversion
1 = invert
Bit 4/TSYNC Invert (TSYNCINV)
0 = no inversion
1 = invert
Bit 5/RSYNC Invert (RSYNCINV)
0 = no inversion
1 = invert
Bit 6/TCLK Invert (TCLKINV)
0 = no inversion
1 = invert
Bit 7/RCLK Invert (RCLKINV)
0 = no inversion
1 = invert
70 of 238
DS2155
13. LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION
Register Name:
LBCR
Register Description:
Register Address:
Loopback Control Register
4Ah
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
LIUC
0
3
LLB
0
2
RLB
0
1
PLB
0
0
FLB
0
Bit 0/Framer Loopback (FLB). This loopback is useful in testing and debugging applications. In FLB, the
DS2155 loops data from the transmit side back to the receive side. When FLB is enabled, the following occurs:
1) T1 Mode: An unframed all-ones code is transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO.
E1 Mode: Normal data is transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO.
2) Data at RPOSI and RNEGI is ignored.
3) All receive-side signals take on timing synchronous with TCLK instead of RCLKI.
Please note that it is not acceptable to have RCLK connected to TCLK during this loopback because this
causes an unstable condition.
0 = loopback disabled
1 = loopback enabled
Bit 1/Payload Loopback (PLB). When PLB is enabled, the following occurs:
1) Data is transmitted from the TPOSO and TNEGO pins synchronous with RCLK instead of TCLK.
2) All the receive side signals continue to operate normally.
3) Data at the TSER, TDATA, and TSIG pins is ignored.
4) The TLCLK signal becomes synchronous with RCLK instead of TCLK.
0 = loopback disabled
1 = loopback enabled
T1 Mode. Normally, this loopback is only enabled when ESF framing is being performed but can also be
enabled in D4 framing applications. In a PLB situation, the DS2155 loops the 192 bits of payload data
(with BPVs corrected) from the receive section back to the transmit section. The FPS framing pattern,
CRC6 calculation, and the FDL bits are not looped back; they are reinserted by the DS2155.
E1 Mode. In a PLB situation, the DS2155 loops the 248 bits of payload data (with BPVs corrected) from
the receive section back to the transmit section. The transmit section modifies the payload as if it was input
at TSER. The FAS word; Si, Sa, and E bits; and CRC4 are not looped back; they are reinserted by the
DS2155.
Bit 2/Remote Loopback (RLB). In this loopback, data input by the RPOSI and RNEGI pins is transmitted back to
the TPOSO and TNEGO pins. Data continues to pass through the receive-side framer of the DS2155 as it would
normally. Data from the transmit-side formatter is ignored. See Figure 3-1 for more details.
0 = loopback disabled
1 = loopback enabled
71 of 238
DS2155
Bit 3/Local Loopback (LLB). In this loopback, data continues to be transmitted as normal through the transmit
side of the SCT. Data being received at RTIP and RRING are replaced with the data being transmitted. Data in this
loopback passes through the jitter attenuator. See Figure 3-2 for more details.
0 = loopback disabled
1 = loopback enabled
Bit 4/Line Interface Unit Mux Control (LIUC). This is a software version of the LIUC pin. When the LIUC pin
is connected high, the LIUC bit has control. When the LIUC pin is connected low, the framer and LIU are
separated and the LIUC bit has no effect
0 = if LIUC pin connected high, LIU internally connected to framer block and deactivate the
TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins
1 = if LIUC pin connected high, disconnect LIU from framer block and activate the
TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins
LIUC Pin
LIUC Bit
Condition
0
0
1
0
1
0
LIU and framer separated
LIU and framer separated
LIU and framer connected
LIU and framer separated
1
1
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
72 of 238
DS2155
13.1Per-Channel Loopback
The per-channel loopback registers (PCLRs) determine which channels (if any) from the backplane
should be replaced with the data from the receive side or, i.e., off of the T1 or E1 line. If this loopback is
enabled, then transmit and receive clocks and frame syncs must be synchronized. One method to
accomplish this is to connect RCLK to TCLK and RFSYNC to TSYNC. There are no restrictions on
which channels can be looped back or on how many channels can be looped back.
Each of the bit positions in the per-channel loopback registers (PCLR1/PCLR2/PCLR3/PCLR4)
represents a DS0 channel in the outgoing frame. When these bits are set to a 1, data from the
corresponding receive channel replaces the data on TSER for that channel.
Register Name:
PCLR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 1
4Bh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH8
0
6
CH7
0
5
CH6
0
4
CH5
0
3
CH4
0
2
CH3
0
1
CH2
0
0
CH1
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8)
0 = loopback disabled
1 = enable loopback; source data from the corresponding receive channel
Register Name:
PCLR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 2
4Ch
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH16
0
6
CH15
0
5
CH14
0
4
CH13
0
3
CH12
0
2
CH11
0
1
CH10
0
0
CH9
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16)
0 = loopback disabled
1 = enable loopback; source data from the corresponding receive channel
73 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
PCLR3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 3
4Dh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH24
0
6
CH23
0
5
CH22
0
4
CH21
0
3
CH20
0
2
CH19
0
1
CH18
0
0
CH17
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24)
0 = loopback disabled
1 = enable loopback; source data from the corresponding receive channel
Register Name:
PCLR4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 4
4Eh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH32
0
6
CH31
0
5
CH30
0
4
CH29
0
3
CH28
0
2
CH27
0
1
CH26
0
0
CH25
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 25 to 32 (CH25 to CH32)
0 = loopback disabled
1 = enable loopback; source data from the corresponding receive channel
74 of 238
DS2155
14. ERROR COUNT REGISTERS
The DS2155 contains four counters that are used to accumulate line-coding errors, path errors, and
synchronization errors. Counter update options include one-second boundaries, 42ms (T1 mode only),
62ms (E1 mode only), or manual. See Error-Counter Configuration Register (ERCNT). When updated
automatically, the user can use the interrupt from the timer to determine when to read these registers. All
four counters saturate at their respective maximum counts, and they do not roll over. Note: Only the line-
code violation count register has the potential to overflow, but the bit error would have to exceed 10E-2
before this would occur.
Register Name:
ERCNT
Register Description:
Register Address:
Error-Counter Configuration Register
41h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
MECU
0
5
ECUS
0
4
EAMS
0
3
VCRFS
0
2
FSBE
0
1
0
MOSCRF LCVCRF
0
0
Bit 0/T1 Line-Code Violation Count Register Function Select (LCVCRF)
0 = do not count excessive 0s
1 = count excessive 0s
Bit 1/Multiframe Out-of-Sync Count Register Function Select (MOSCRF)
0 = count errors in the framing bit position
1 = count the number of multiframes out-of-sync
Bit 2/PCVCR Fs-Bit Error-Report Enable (FSBE)
0 = do not report bit errors in Fs-bit position; only Ft-bit position
1 = report bit errors in Fs-bit position as well as Ft-bit position
Bit 3/E1 Line-Code Violation Count Register Function Select (VCRFS)
0 = count bipolar violations (BPVs)
1 = count code violations (CVs)
Bit 4/Error-Accumulation Mode Select (EAMS)
0 = ERCNT.5 determines accumulation time
1 = ERCNT.6 determines accumulation time
Bit 5/Error-Counter Update Select (ECUS)
T1 Mode:
0 = update error counters once a second
1 = update error counters every 42ms (333 frames)
E1 Mode:
0 = update error counters once a second
1 = update error counters every 62.5ms (500 frames)
Bit 6/Manual Error-Counter Update (MECU). When enabled by ERCNT.4, the changing of this bit from a 0 to
a 1 allows the next clock cycle to load the error-counter registers with the latest counts and reset the counters. The
user must wait a minimum of 1.5 RCLK clock periods before reading the error count registers to allow for proper
update.
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
75 of 238
DS2155
14.1Line-Code Violation Count Register (LCVCR)
14.1.1 T1 Operation
T1 code violations are defined as bipolar violations (BPVs) or excessive 0s. If the B8ZS mode is set for
the receive side, then B8ZS codewords are not counted. This counter is always enabled; it is not disabled
during receive loss-of-synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. Table 14-A shows what the LCVCRs
count.
Table 14-A. T1 Line Code Violation Counting Options
COUNT EXCESSIVE
B8ZS ENABLED?
ZEROS?
(ERCNT.0)
No
COUNTED IN THE LCVCRs
(T1RCR2.5)
No
No
BPVs
Yes
No
BPVs + 16 consecutive 0s
Yes
Yes
BPVs (B8ZS codewords not counted)
BPVs + 8 consecutive 0s
Yes
14.1.2 E1 Operation
Either bipolar violations or code violations can be counted. Bipolar violations are defined as consecutive
marks of the same polarity. In this mode, if the HDB3 mode is set for the receive side, then HDB3
codewords are not counted as BPVs. If ERCNT.3 is set, then the LVC counts code violations as defined
in ITU O.161. Code violations are defined as consecutive bipolar violations of the same polarity. In most
applications, the framer should be programmed to count BPVs when receiving AMI code and to count
CVs when receiving HDB3 code. This counter increments at all times and is not disabled by loss-of-sync
conditions. The counter saturates at 65,535 and does not roll over. The bit-error rate on an E1 line would
have to be greater than 10-2 before the VCR would saturate (Table 14-B).
Table 14-B. E1 Line-Code Violation Counting Options
E1 CODE VIOLATION SELECT
COUNTED IN THE LCVCRs
(ERCNT.3)
0
1
BPVs
CVs
76 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
LCVCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Line-Code Violation Count Register 1
42h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LCVC15 LCVC14 LCVC13 LCVC12 LCVC11 LCVC10 LCVC9 LCCV8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Line-Code Violation Counter Bits 8 to 15 (LCVC8 to LCVC15). LCV15 is the MSB of the 16-bit
code violation count.
Register Name:
LCVCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Line-Code Violation Count Register 2
43h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LCVC0
0
LCVC7 LCVC6 LCVC5 LCVC4 LCVC3 LCVC2 LCVC1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Line-Code Violation Counter Bits 0 to 7 (LCVC0 to LCVC7). LCV0 is the LSB of the 16-bit code
violation count.
77 of 238
DS2155
14.2Path Code Violation Count Register (PCVCR)
14.2.1 T1 Operation
The path code violation count register records Ft, Fs, or CRC6 errors in T1 frames. When the receive side
of a framer is set to operate in the T1 ESF framing mode, PCVCR records errors in the CRC6 codewords.
When set to operate in the T1 D4 framing mode, PCVCR counts errors in the Ft framing bit position.
Through the ERCNT.2 bit, a framer can be programmed to also report errors in the Fs framing bit
position. The PCVCR is disabled during receive loss-of-synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions.
Table 14-C shows what errors the PCVCR counts.
Table 14-C. T1 Path Code Violation Counting Arrangements
COUNTED
FRAMING MODE
COUNT Fs ERRORS?
IN THE PCVCRs
D4
D4
ESF
No
Yes
Don’t Care
Errors in the Ft pattern
Errors in both the Ft and Fs patterns
Errors in the CRC6 codewords
14.2.2 E1 Operation
The path code violation-count register records CRC4 errors. Since the maximum CRC4 count in a one-
second period is 1000, this counter cannot saturate. The counter is disabled during loss-of-sync at either
the FAS or CRC4 level; it continues to count if loss-of-multiframe sync occurs at the CAS level.
Path code violation-count register 1 (PCVCR1) is the most significant word and PCVCR2 is the least
significant word of a 16-bit counter that records path violations (PVs).
Register Name:
PCVCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Path Code Violation Count Register 1
44h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCVC15 PCVC14 PCVC13 PCVC12 PCVC11 PCVC10 PCVC9 PCVC8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Path Code Violation Counter Bits 8 to 15 (PCVC8 to PCVC15). PCVC15 is the MSB of the 16-bit
path code violation count.
Register Name:
PCVCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Path Code Violation Count Register 2
45h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCVC0
0
PCVC7 PCVC6 PCVC5 PCVC4 PCVC3 PCVC2 PCVC1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Path Code Violation Counter Bits 0 to 7 (PCVC0 to PCVC7). PCVC0 is the LSB of the 16-bit path
code violation count.
78 of 238
DS2155
14.3Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register (FOSCR)
14.3.1 T1 Operation
The FOSCR is used to count the number of multiframes that the receive synchronizer is out of sync. This
number is useful in ESF applications needing to measure the parameters loss-of-frame count (LOFC) and
ESF error events as described in AT&T publication TR54016. When the FOSCR is operated in this
mode, it is not disabled during receive loss-of-synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. The FOSCR has
an alternate operating mode whereby it counts either errors in the Ft framing pattern (in the D4 mode) or
errors in the FPS framing pattern (in the ESF mode). When the FOSCR is operated in this mode, it is
disabled during receive loss-of-synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. Table 14-D shows what the
FOSCR is capable of counting.
Table 14-D. T1 Frames Out-of-Sync Counting Arrangements
COUNT MOS OR
FRAMING MODE
F-BIT ERRORS
(ERCNT.1)
MOS
COUNTED IN THE FOSCRs
(T1RCR1.3)
D4
D4
Number of multiframes out-of-sync
Errors in the Ft pattern
Number of multiframes out-of-sync
Errors in the FPS pattern
F-Bit
MOS
ESF
ESF
F-Bit
14.3.2 E1 Operation
The FOSCR counts word errors in the FAS in time slot 0. This counter is disabled when RLOS is high.
FAS errors are not counted when the framer is searching for FAS alignment and/or synchronization at
either the CAS or CRC4 multiframe level. Since the maximum FAS word error count in a one-second
period is 4000, this counter cannot saturate.
The frames out-of-sync count register 1 (FOSCR1) is the most significant word and FOSCR2 is the least
significant word of a 16-bit counter that records frames out-of-sync.
Register Name:
FOSCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register 1
46h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FOS15
0
6
FOS14
0
5
FOS13
0
4
FOS12
0
3
2
1
FOS9
0
0
FOS8
0
FOS11 FOS10
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Frames Out-of-Sync Counter Bits 8 to 15 (FOS8 to FOS15). FOS15 is the MSB of the 16-bit frames
out-of-sync count.
Register Name:
FOSCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register 2
47h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FOS7
0
6
FOS6
0
5
FOS5
0
4
FOS4
0
3
FOS3
0
2
FOS2
0
1
FOS1
0
0
FOS0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Frames Out-of-Sync Counter Bits 0 to 7 (FOS0 to FOS7). FOS0 is the LSB of the 16-bit frames out-
of-sync count.
79 of 238
DS2155
14.4E-Bit Counter (EBCR)
This counter is only available in E1 mode. E-bit count register 1 (EBCR1) is the most significant word
and EBCR2 is the least significant word of a 16-bit counter that records far-end block errors (FEBE) as
reported in the first bit of frames 13 and 15 on E1 lines running with CRC4 multiframe. These count
registers increment once each time the received E-bit is set to 0. Since the maximum E-bit count in a one-
second period is 1000, this counter cannot saturate. The counter is disabled during loss-of-sync at either
the FAS or CRC4 level; it continues to count if loss-of-multiframe sync occurs at the CAS level.
Register Name:
EBCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
E-Bit Count Register 1
48h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EB15
0
6
EB14
0
5
EB13
0
4
EB12
0
3
EB11
0
2
EB10
0
1
EB9
0
0
EB8
0
Bits 0 to 7/E-Bit Counter Bits 8 to 15 (EB8 to EB15). EB15 is the MSB of the 16-bit E-bit count.
Register Name:
EBCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
E-Bit Count Register 2
49h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EB7
0
6
EB6
0
5
EB5
0
4
EB4
0
3
EB3
0
2
EB2
0
1
EB1
0
0
EB0
0
Bits 0 to 7/E-Bit Counter Bits 0 to 7 (EB0 to EB7). EB0 is the LSB of the 16-bit E-bit count.
80 of 238
DS2155
15. DS0 MONITORING FUNCTION
The DS2155 has the ability to monitor one DS0 64kbps channel in the transmit direction and one DS0
channel in the receive direction at the same time. In the transmit direction, the user determines which
channel is to be monitored by properly setting the TCM0 to TCM4 bits in the TDS0SEL register. In the
receive direction, the RCM0 to RCM4 bits in the RDS0SEL register need to be properly set. The DS0
channel pointed to by the TCM0 to TCM4 bits appear in the transmit DS0 monitor (TDS0M) register.
The DS0 channel pointed to by the RCM0 to RCM4 bits appear in the receive DS0 (RDS0M) register.
The TCM4 to TCM0 and RCM4 to RCM0 bits should be programmed with the decimal decode of the
appropriate T1or E1 channel. T1 channels 1 through 24 map to register values 0 through 23. E1 channels
1 through 32 map to register values 0 through 31. For example, if DS0 channel 6 in the transmit direction
and DS0 channel 15 in the receive direction needed to be monitored, then the following values would be
programmed into TDS0SEL and RDS0SEL:
TCM4 = 0
TCM3 = 0
TCM2 = 1
TCM1 = 0
TCM0 = 1
RCM4 = 0
RCM3 = 1
RCM2 = 1
RCM1 = 1
RCM0 = 0
Register Name:
TDS0SEL
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Channel Monitor Select
74h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
TCM4
0
3
TCM3
0
2
TCM2
0
1
TCM1
0
0
TCM0
0
Bits 0 to 4/Transmit Channel Monitor Bits (TCM0 to TCM4). TCM0 is the LSB of a 5-bit channel select that
determines which transmit channel data appear in the TDS0M register.
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Register Name:
TDS0M
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit DS0 Monitor Register
75h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
B1
0
6
B2
0
5
B3
0
4
B4
0
3
B5
0
2
B6
0
1
B7
0
0
B8
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit DS0 Channel Bits (B1 to B8). Transmit channel data that has been selected by the transmit
channel monitor select register. B8 is the LSB of the DS0 channel (last bit to be transmitted).
81 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RDS0SEL
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Channel Monitor Select
76h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
RCM4
0
3
2
1
RCM1
0
0
RCM0
0
RCM3 RCM2
0
0
Bits 0 to 4/Receive Channel Monitor Bits (RCM0 to RCM4). RCM0 is the LSB of a 5-bit channel select that
determines which receive DS0 channel data appear in the RDS0M register.
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Register Name:
RDS0M
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive DS0 Monitor Register
77h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
B1
0
6
B2
0
5
B3
0
4
B4
0
3
B5
0
2
B6
0
1
B7
0
0
B8
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive DS0 Channel Bits (B1 to B8). Receive channel data that has been selected by the receive
channel monitor select register. B8 is the LSB of the DS0 channel (last bit to be received).
82 of 238
DS2155
16. SIGNALING OPERATION
There are two methods to access receive signaling data and provide transmit signaling data, processor-
based (software-based) or hardware-based. Processor-based refers to access through the transmit and
receive signaling registers RS1–RS16 and TS1–TS16. Hardware-based refers to the TSIG and RSIG pins.
Both methods can be used simultaneously.
16.1Receive Signaling
Figure 16-1. Simplified Diagram of Receive Signaling Path
PER-CHANNEL
CONTROL
T1/E1 DATA STREAM
ALL-ONES
RSER
SIGNALING
EXTRACTION
RECEIVE SIGNALING
REGISTERS
REINSERTION
RSYNC
RSIG
CONTROL
SIGNALING
BUFFERS
CHANGE-OF-STATE
INDICATION
REGISTERS
16.1.1 Processor-Based Signaling
The robbed-bit signaling (T1) or TS16 CAS signaling (E1) is sampled in the receive data stream and
copied into the receive signaling registers, RS1–RS16. In T1 mode, only RS1–RS12 are used. The
signaling information in these registers is always updated on multiframe boundaries. This function is
always enabled.
16.1.1.1 Change-of-State
To avoid constant monitoring of the receive signaling registers, the DS2155 can be programmed to alert
the host when any specific channel or channels undergo a change of their signaling state.
RSCSE1–RSCSE4 for E1 and RSCSE1–RSCSE3 for T1 are used to select which channels can cause a
change-of-state indication. The change-of-state is indicated in status register 5 (SR1.5). If signaling
integration (CCR1.5) is enabled, then the new signaling state must be constant for three multiframes
before a change-of-state is indicated. The user can enable the INT pin to toggle low upon detection of a
change in signaling by setting the IMR1.5 bit. The signaling integration mode is global and cannot be
enabled on a channel-by-channel basis.
The user can identity which channels have undergone a signaling change-of-state by reading the
RSINFO1–RSINFO4 registers. The information from these registers inform the user which RSx register
to read for the new signaling data. All changes are indicated in the RSINFO1–RSINFO4 registers
regardless of the RSCSE1–RSCSE4 registers.
83 of 238
DS2155
16.1.2 Hardware-Based Receive Signaling
In hardware-based signaling the signaling data can be obtained from the RSER pin or the RSIG pin.
RSIG is a signaling PCM stream output on a channel-by-channel basis from the signaling buffer. The
signaling data, T1 robbed bit or E1 TS16, is still present in the original data stream at RSER. The
signaling buffer provides signaling data to the RSIG pin and also allows signaling data to be reinserted
into the original data stream in a different alignment that is determined by a multiframe signal from the
RSYNC pin. In this mode, the receive elastic store can be enabled or disabled. If the receive elastic store
is enabled, then the backplane clock (RSYSCLK) can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. In the ESF
framing mode, the ABCD signaling bits are output on RSIG in the lower nibble of each channel. The
RSIG data is updated once a multiframe (3ms) unless a freeze is in effect. In the D4 framing mode, the
AB signaling bits are output twice on RSIG in the lower nibble of each channel. Hence, bits 5 and 6
contain the same data as bits 7 and 8, respectively, in each channel. The RSIG data is updated once a
multiframe (1.5ms) unless a freeze is in effect. See the timing diagrams in Section 35 for some examples.
16.1.2.1 Receive Signaling Reinsertion at RSER
In this mode, the user provides a multiframe sync at the RSYNC pin and the signaling data is reinserted
based on this alignment. In T1 mode, this results in two copies of the signaling data in the RSER data
stream, the original signaling data and the realigned data. This is of little consequence in voice channels.
Reinsertion can be avoided in data channels since this feature is activated on a per-channel basis. In this
mode, the elastic store must be enabled; however, the backplane clock can be either 1.544MHz or
2.048MHz.
Signaling reinsertion can be enabled on a per-channel basis by setting the RSRCS bit high in the PCPR
register. The channels that will have signaling reinserted are selected by writing to the PCDR1–PCDR3
registers for T1 mode and PCDR1–PCDR4 registers for E1 mode. In E1 mode, the user generally selects
all channels or none for reinsertion. In E1 mode, signaling reinsertion on all channels can be enabled with
a single bit, SIGCR.7 (GRSRE). This bit allows the user to reinsert all signaling channels without having
to program all channels through the per-channel function.
16.1.2.2 Force Receive Signaling All Ones
In T1 mode, the user can, on a per-channel basis, force the robbed-bit signaling bit positions to a 1 by
using the per-channel register (Section 7). The user sets the BTCS bit in the PCPR register. The channels
that will be forced to 1 are selected by writing to the PCDR1–PCDR3 registers.
16.1.2.3 Receive Signaling Freeze
The signaling data in the four multiframe signaling buffers is frozen in a known good state upon either a
loss of synchronization (OOF event), carrier loss, or frame slip. This action meets the requirements of
BellCore TR–TSY–000170 for signaling freezing. To allow this freeze action to occur, the RFE control
bit (SIGCR.4) should be set high. The user can force a freeze by setting the RFF control bit (SIGCR.3)
high. The RSIGF output pin provides a hardware indication that a freeze is in effect. The four-multiframe
buffer provides a three-multiframe delay in the signaling bits provided at the RSIG pin (and at the RSER
pin if receive signaling reinsertion is enabled). When freezing is enabled (RFE = 1), the signaling data is
held in the last-known good state until the corrupting error condition subsides. When the error condition
subsides, the signaling data is held in the old state for at least an additional 9ms (or 4.5ms in D4 framing
mode) before updating with new signaling data.
84 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SIGCR
Register Description:
Register Address:
Signaling Control Register
40h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
GRSRE
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
RFE
0
3
RFF
0
2
RCCS
0
1
TCCS
0
0
FRSAO
0
Bit 0/Force Receive Signaling All Ones (FRSAO). In T1 mode, this bit forces all signaling data at the RSIG and
RSER pin to all ones. This bit has no effect in E1 mode.
0 = normal signaling data at RSIG and RSER
1 = force signaling data at RSIG and RSER to all ones
Bit 1/Transmit Time Slot Control for CAS Signaling (TCCS). Controls the order that signaling is transmitted
from the transmit signaling registers. This bit should be set = 0 in T1 mode.
0 = signaling data is CAS format
1 = signaling data is CCS format
Bit 2/Receive Time Slot Control for CAS Signaling (RCCS). Controls the order that signaling is placed into the
receive signaling registers. This bit should be set = 0 in T1 mode.
0 = signaling data is CAS format
1 = signaling data is CCS format
Bit 3/Receive Force Freeze (RFF). Freezes receive-side signaling at RSIG (and RSER if receive signaling
reinsertion is enabled); overrides receive freeze enable (RFE). See Section 16.1.2.3 for details.
0 = do not force a freeze event
1 = force a freeze event
Bit 4/Receive Freeze Enable (RFE). See Section 16.1.2.3 for details.
0 = no freezing of receive signaling data occurs
1 = allow freezing of receive signaling data at RSIG (and RSER if receive signaling reinsertion is enabled)
Bits 5, 6/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Bit 7/Global Receive Signaling Reinsertion Enable (GRSRE). This bit allows the user to reinsert all signaling
channels without programming all channels through the per-channel function.
0 = do not reinsert all signaling
1 = reinsert all signaling
85 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RS1 to RS12
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, ESF Format)
60h to 6Bh
(MSB)
(LSB)
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH2-C
CH4-C
CH6-C
CH8-C
CH2-D
CH4-D
CH6-D
CH8-D
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH1-C
CH3-C
CH5-C
CH7-C
CH9-C
CH1-D
CH3-D
CH5-D
CH7-D
CH9-D
RS1
RS2
RS3
RS4
RS5
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-C CH10-D CH9-A
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-C CH12-D CH11-A CH11-B CH11-C CH11-D RS6
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-C CH14-D CH13-A CH13-B CH13-C CH13-D RS7
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-C CH16-D CH15-A CH15-B CH15-C CH15-D RS8
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-C CH18-D CH17-A CH17-B CH17-C CH17-D RS9
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-C CH20-D CH19-A CH19-B CH19-C CH19-D RS10
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-C CH22-D CH21-A CH21-B CH21-C CH21-D RS11
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-C CH24-D CH23-A CH23-B CH23-C CH23-D RS12
Register Name:
RS1 to RS12
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, D4 Format)
60h to 6Bh
(MSB)
(LSB)
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH9-A
RS1
RS2
RS3
RS4
RS5
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-A
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-A
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-A
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-A
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-A
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-A
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-A
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-A
CH10-B CH9-A
CH12-B CH11-A CH11-B
CH14-B CH13-A CH13-B
CH16-B CH15-A CH15-B
CH18-B CH17-A CH17-B
CH20-B CH19-A CH19-B
CH22-B CH21-A CH21-B
CH24-B CH23-A CH23-B
CH11-A CH11-B RS6
CH13-A CH13-B RS7
CH15-A CH15-B RS8
CH17-A CH17-B RS9
CH19-A CH19-B RS10
CH21-A CH21-B RS11
CH23-A CH23-B RS12
Note: In D4 format, TS1–TS12 contain signaling data for two frames. Bold type indicates data for second frame.
86 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RS1 to RS16
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CAS Format)
60h to 6Fh
(MSB)
(LSB)
0
0
0
0
X
Y
X
X
RS1
RS2
RS3
RS4
RS5
RS6
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH2-C
CH4-C
CH6-C
CH8-C
CH2-D
CH4-D
CH6-D
CH8-D
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH1-C
CH3-C
CH5-C
CH7-C
CH9-C
CH1-D
CH3-D
CH5-D
CH7-D
CH9-D
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-C CH10-D CH9-A
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-C CH12-D CH11-A CH11-B CH11-C CH11-D RS7
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-C CH14-D CH13-A CH13-B CH13-C CH13-D RS8
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-C CH16-D CH15-A CH15-B CH15-C CH15-D RS9
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-C CH18-D CH17-A CH17-B CH17-C CH17-D RS10
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-C CH20-D CH19-A CH19-B CH19-C CH19-D RS11
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-C CH22-D CH21-A CH21-B CH21-C CH21-D RS12
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-C CH24-D CH23-A CH23-B CH23-C CH23-D RS13
CH26-A CH26-B CH26-C CH26-D CH25-A CH25-B CH25-C CH25-D RS14
CH28-A CH28-B CH28-C CH28-D CH27-A CH27-B CH27-C CH27-D RS15
CH30-A CH30-B CH30-C CH30-D CH29-A CH29-B CH29-C CH29-D RS16
Register Name:
RS1 to RS16
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format)
60h to 6Fh
(MSB)
(LSB)
1
9
2
10
18
26
34
42
50
58
66
74
82
90
98
106
114
122
3
11
19
27
35
43
51
59
67
75
83
91
99
107
115
123
4
5
6
7
8
RS1
12
13
14
15
16
RS2
17
25
33
41
49
57
65
73
81
89
97
105
113
121
20
21
22
23
24
RS3
28
29
30
31
32
RS4
36
37
38
39
40
RS5
44
45
46
47
48
RS6
52
53
54
55
56
RS7
60
61
62
63
64
RS8
68
69
70
71
72
RS9
76
77
78
79
80
RS10
RS11
RS12
RS13
RS14
RS15
RS16
84
85
86
87
88
92
93
94
95
96
100
108
116
124
101
109
117
125
102
110
118
126
103
111
119
127
104
112
120
128
87 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RSCSE1, RSCSE2, RSCSE3, RSCSE4
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable
3Ch, 3Dh, 3Eh, 3Fh
Register Description:
Register Address:
(MSB)
(LSB)
CH8
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH6
CH5
CH4
CH3
CH2
CH1
RSCSE1
RSCSE2
RSCSE3
RSCSE4
CH16
CH24
CH14
CH22
CH30
CH13
CH21
CH29
CH12
CH20
CH28
CH11
CH19
CH27
CH10
CH18
CH26
CH9
CH17
CH25
Setting any of the CH1–CH30 bits in the RSCSE1–RSCSE4 registers causes an interrupt when that channel’s
signaling data changes state.
Register Name:
RSINFO1, RSINFO2, RSINFO3, RSINFO4
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information
38h, 39h, 3Ah, 3Bh
Register Description:
Register Address:
(MSB)
(LSB)
CH1
CH8
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH6
CH5
CH4
CH3
CH2
RSINFO1
RSINFO2
RSINFO3
RSINFO4
CH16
CH24
CH14
CH22
CH30
CH13
CH21
CH29
CH12
CH20
CH28
CH11
CH19
CH27
CH10
CH18
CH26
CH9
CH17
CH25
When a channel’s signaling data changes state, the respective bit in registers RSINFO1–4 is set. An interrupt is
generated if the channel was also enabled as an interrupt source by setting the appropriate bit in RSCSE1–4. The
bit remains set until read.
88 of 238
DS2155
16.2Transmit Signaling
Figure 16-2. Simplified Diagram of Transmit Signaling Path
TRANSMIT
SIGNALING
REGISTERS
1
0
1
0
1
TSER
TSIG
T1/E1 DATA
STREAM
0
B7
SIGNALING
BUFFERS
T1TCR1.4
PER-CHANNEL
CONTROL
PER-CHANNEL
CONTROL
SSIE1 - SSIE4
PCPR.3
ONLY APPLIES TO T1 MODE
16.2.1 Processor-Based Mode
In processor-based mode, signaling data is loaded into the transmit signaling registers (TS1–TS16) by the
host interface. On multiframe boundaries, the contents of these registers are loaded into a shift register for
placement in the appropriate bit position in the outgoing data stream. The user can employ the transmit
multiframe interrupt in status register 4 (SR4.4) to know when to update the signaling bits. The user need
not update any transmit signaling register for which there is no change-of-state for that register.
Each transmit signaling register contains the robbed-bit signaling (T1) or TS16 CAS signaling (E1) for
two time slots that are inserted into the outgoing stream, if enabled to do so through T1TCR1.4 (T1
mode) or E1TCR1.6 (E1 mode). In T1 mode, only TS1–TS12 are used.
Signaling data can be sourced from the TS registers on a per-channel basis by using the software
signaling insertion enable registers, SSIE1–SSIE4.
16.2.1.1 T1 Mode
In T1 ESF framing mode, there are four signaling bits per channel (A, B, C, and D). TS1–TS12 contain a
full multiframe of signaling data. In T1 D4 framing mode, there are only two signaling bits per channel
(A and B). In T1 D4 framing mode, the framer uses the C and D bit positions as the A and B bit positions
for the next multiframe. In D4 mode, two multiframes of signaling data can be loaded into TS1–TS12.
The framer loads the contents of TS1–TS12 into the outgoing shift register every other D4 multiframe. In
D4 mode, the host should load new contents into TS1–TS12 on every other multiframe boundary and no
later than 120µs after the boundary.
89 of 238
DS2155
16.2.1.2 E1 Mode
In E1 mode, TS16 carries the signaling information. This information can be in either CCS (common
channel signaling) or CAS (channel associated signaling) format. The 32 time slots are referenced by two
different channel number schemes in E1. In “Channel” numbering, TS0–TS31 are labeled channels 1
through 32. In “Phone Channel” numbering, TS1–TS15 are labeled channel 1 through channel 15 and
TS17–TS31 are labeled channel 15 through channel 30.
Table 16-A. Time Slot Numbering Schemes
TS
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10111213141516171819202122232425262728293031
Channel 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011121314151617181920212223242526272829303132
Phone
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112131415 161718192021222324252627282930
Channel
90 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TS1 to TS16
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CAS Format)
50h to 5Fh
(MSB)
(LSB)
0
0
0
0
X
Y
X
X
TS1
TS2
TS3
TS4
TS5
TS6
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH2-C
CH4-C
CH6-C
CH8-C
CH2-D
CH4-D
CH6-D
CH8-D
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH1-C
CH3-C
CH5-C
CH7-C
CH9-C
CH1-D
CH3-D
CH5-D
CH7-D
CH9-D
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-C CH10-D CH9-A
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-C CH12-D CH11-A CH11-B CH11-C CH11-D TS7
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-C CH14-D CH13-A CH13-B CH13-C CH13-D TS8
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-C CH16-D CH15-A CH15-B CH15-C CH15-D TS9
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-C CH18-D CH17-A CH17-B CH17-C CH17-D TS10
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-C CH20-D CH19-A CH19-B CH19-C CH19-D TS11
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-C CH22-D CH21-A CH21-B CH21-C CH21-D TS12
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-C CH24-D CH23-A CH23-B CH23-C CH23-D TS13
CH26-A CH26-B CH26-C CH26-D CH25-A CH25-B CH25-C CH25-D TS14
CH28-A CH28-B CH28-C CH28-D CH27-A CH27-B CH27-C CH27-D TS15
CH30-A CH30-B CH30-C CH30-D CH29-A CH29-B CH29-C CH29-D TS16
Register Name:
TS1 to TS16
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format)
50h to 5Fh
(MSB)
(LSB)
1
9
2
10
18
26
34
42
50
58
66
74
82
90
98
106
114
122
3
11
19
27
35
43
51
59
67
75
83
91
99
107
115
123
4
5
6
7
8
TS1
12
13
14
15
16
24
TS2
17
25
33
41
49
57
65
73
81
89
97
105
113
121
20
21
22
23
TS3
28
29
30
31
32
TS4
36
37
38
39
40
TS5
44
45
46
47
48
TS6
52
53
54
55
56
TS7
60
61
62
63
64
TS8
68
69
70
71
72
TS9
76
77
78
79
80
TS10
TS11
TS12
TS13
TS14
TS15
TS16
84
85
86
87
88
92
93
94
95
96
100
108
116
124
101
109
117
125
102
110
118
126
103
111
119
127
104
112
120
128
91 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TS1 to TS12
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, ESF Format)
50h to 5Bh
(MSB)
(LSB)
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH2-C
CH4-C
CH6-C
CH8-C
CH2-D
CH4-D
CH6-D
CH8-D
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH1-C
CH3-C
CH5-C
CH7-C
CH9-C
CH1-D
CH3-D
CH5-D
CH7-D
CH9-D
TS1
TS2
TS3
TS4
TS5
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-C CH10-D CH9-A
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-C CH12-D CH11-A CH11-B CH11-C CH11-D TS6
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-C CH14-D CH13-A CH13-B CH13-C CH13-D TS7
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-C CH16-D CH15-A CH15-B CH15-C CH15-D TS8
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-C CH18-D CH17-A CH17-B CH17-C CH17-D TS9
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-C CH20-D CH19-A CH19-B CH19-C CH19-D TS10
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-C CH22-D CH21-A CH21-B CH21-C CH21-D TS11
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-C CH24-D CH23-A CH23-B CH23-C CH23-D TS12
Register Name:
TS1 to TS12
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, D4 Format)
50h to 5Bh
(MSB)
(LSB)
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH9-A
TS1
TS2
TS3
TS4
TS5
CH10-A CH10-B
CH12-A CH12-B
CH14-A CH14-B
CH16-A CH16-B
CH18-A CH18-B
CH20-A CH20-B
CH22-A CH22-B
CH24-A CH24-B
CH10-A CH10-B CH9-A
CH12-A CH12-B CH11-A CH11-B
CH14-A CH14-B CH13-A CH13-B
CH16-A CH16-B CH15-A CH15-B
CH18-A CH18-B CH17-A CH17-B
CH20-A CH20-B CH19-A CH19-B
CH22-A CH22-B CH21-A CH21-B
CH24-A CH24-B CH23-A CH23-B
CH11-A CH11-B TS6
CH13-A CH13-B TS7
CH15-A CH15-B TS8
CH17-A CH17-B TS9
CH19-A CH19-B TS10
CH21-A CH21-B TS11
CH23-A CH23-B TS12
Note: In D4 format, TS1–TS12 contain signaling data for two frames. Bold type indicates data for second frame.
92 of 238
DS2155
16.2.2 Software Signaling Insertion-Enable Registers, E1 CAS Mode
In E1 CAS mode, the CAS signaling alignment/alarm byte can be sourced from the transmit signaling
registers along with the signaling data.
Register Name:
SSIE1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1
08h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH7
0
6
CH6
0
5
CH5
0
4
CH4
0
3
CH3
0
2
CH2
0
1
CH1
0
0
UCAW
0
Bit 0/Upper CAS Align/Alarm Word (UCAW). Selects the upper CAS align/alarm pattern (0000) to be sourced
from the upper 4 bits of the TS1 register.
0 = do not source the upper CAS align/alarm pattern from the TS1 register
1 = source the upper CAS align/alarm pattern from the TS1 register
Bits 1 to 7/Software Signaling-Insertion Enable for Channels 1 to 7 (CH1 to CH7). These bits determine
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
Register Name:
SSIE2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 2
09h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH15
0
6
CH14
0
5
CH13
0
4
CH12
0
3
CH11
0
2
CH10
0
1
CH9
0
0
CH8
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 8 to 15 (CH8 to CH15). These bits determine
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
93 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SSIE3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 3
0Ah
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH22
0
6
CH21
0
5
CH20
0
4
CH19
0
3
CH18
0
2
CH17
0
1
CH16
0
0
LCAW
0
Bit 0/Lower CAS Align/Alarm Word (LCAW). Selects the lower CAS align/alarm bits (xyxx) to be sourced
from the lower 4 bits of the TS1 register.
0 = do not source the lower CAS align/alarm bits from the TS1 register
1 = source the lower CAS alarm align/bits from the TS1 register
Bits 1 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for LCAW and Channels 16 to 22 (CH16 to CH22). These
bits determine which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
Register Name:
SSIE4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 4
0Bh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH30
0
6
CH29
0
5
CH28
0
4
CH27
0
3
CH26
0
2
CH25
0
1
CH24
0
0
CH23
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 22 to 30 (CH23 to CH30). These bits determine
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
94 of 238
DS2155
16.2.3 Software Signaling Insertion-Enable Registers, T1 Mode
In T1 mode, only registers SSIE1–SSIE3 are used since there are only 24 channels in a T1 frame.
Register Name:
SSIE1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1
08h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH8
0
6
CH7
0
5
CH6
0
4
CH5
0
3
CH4
0
2
CH3
0
1
CH2
0
0
CH1
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8). These bits determine which
channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
Register Name:
SSIE2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Software Signaling-Insertion Enable 2
09h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH16
0
6
CH15
0
5
CH14
0
4
CH13
0
3
CH12
0
2
CH11
0
1
CH10
0
0
CH9
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16). These bits determine
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
Register Name:
SSIE3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Software Signaling-Insertion Enable 3
0Ah
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH24
0
6
CH23
0
5
CH22
0
4
CH21
0
3
CH20
0
2
CH19
0
1
CH18
0
0
CH17
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24). These bits determine
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel
16.2.4 Hardware-Based Mode
In hardware-based mode, signaling data is input through the TSIG pin. This signaling PCM stream is
buffered and inserted to the data stream being input at the TSER pin.
Signaling data can be inserted on a per-channel basis by the transmit hardware-signaling channel-select
(THSCS) function. The user has the ability to control which channels are to have signaling data from the
TSIG pin inserted into them on a per-channel basis. See Section 7 for details on using this per-channel
(THSCS) feature. The signaling insertion capabilities of the framer are available whether the transmit-
side elastic store is enabled or disabled. If the elastic store is enabled, the backplane clock (TSYSCLK)
can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. Also, if the elastic is enabled in conjunction with transmit
hardware signaling, CCR3.7 must be set = 0.
95 of 238
DS2155
17. PER-CHANNEL IDLE CODE GENERATION
Channel data can be replaced by an idle code on a per-channel basis in the transmit and receive
directions. When operated in the T1 mode, only the first 24 channels are used by the DS2155, the
remaining channels, CH25–CH32, are not used.
The DS2155 contains a 64-byte idle code array accessed by the idle array address register (IAAR) and the
per-channel idle code register (PCICR). The contents of the array contain the idle codes to be substituted
into the appropriate transmit or receive channels. This substitution can be enabled and disabled on a per-
channel basis by the transmit-channel idle code-enable registers (TCICE1–4) and receive-channel idle
code-enable registers (RCICE1–4).
To program idle codes, first select a channel by writing to the IAAR register. Then write the idle code to
the PCICR register. For successive writes there is no need to load the IAAR with the next consecutive
address. The IAAR register automatically increments after a write to the PCICR register. The auto
increment feature can be used for read operations as well. Bits 6 and 7 of the IAAR register can be used
to block write a common idle code to all transmit or receive positions in the array with a single write to
the PCICR register. Bits 6 and 7 of the IAAR register should not be used for read operations. TCICE1–4
and RCICE1–4 are used to enable idle code replacement on a per-channel basis.
Table 17-A. Idle-Code Array Address Mapping
BITS 0 to 5 OF IAAR
MAPS TO CHANNEL
REGISTER
0
Transmit Channel 1
Transmit Channel 2
Transmit Channel 3
—
1
2
—
—
30
31
32
33
34
—
—
62
63
—
Transmit Channel 31
Transmit Channel 32
Receive Channel 1
Receive Channel 2
Receive Channel 3
—
—
Receive Channel 31
Receive Channel 32
96 of 238
DS2155
17.1Idle-Code Programming Examples
Example 1
Sets transmit channel 3 idle code to 7Eh.
Write IAAR = 02h ;select channel 3 in the array
Write PCICR = 7Eh ;set idle code to 7Eh
Example 2
Sets transmit channels 3, 4, 5, and 6 idle code to 7Eh and enables transmission of idle codes for those channels.
Write IAAR = 02h
Write PCICR = 7Eh
Write PCICR = 7Eh
Write PCICR = 7Eh
Write PCICR = 7Eh
Write TCICE1 = 3Ch
;select channel 3 in the array
;set channel 3 idle code to 7Eh
;set channel 4 idle code to 7Eh
;set channel 5 idle code to 7Eh
;set channel 6 idle code to 7Eh
;enable transmission of idle codes for channels 3,4,5, and 6
Example 3
Sets transmit channels 3, 4, 5, and 6 idle code to 7Eh, EEh, FFh, and 7Eh, respectively.
Write IAAR = 02h
Write PCICR = 7Eh
Write PCICR = EEh
Write PCICR = FFh
Write PCICR = 7Eh
Example 4
Sets all transmit idle codes to 7Eh.
Write IAAR = 4xh
Write PCICR = 7Eh
Example 5
Sets all receive and transmit idle codes to 7Eh and enables idle code substitution in all E1 transmit and receive
channels.
Write IAAR = Cxh
Write PCICR = 7Eh
;enable block write to all transmit and receive positions in the array
;7Eh is idle code
Write TCICE1 = FEh ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 2 through 8
;Although an idle code was programmed for channel 1 by the block write
;function above, enabling it for channel 1 would step on the frame
;alignment, alarms, and Sa bits
Write TCICE2 = FFh ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 9 through 16
Write TCICE3 = FEh ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 18 through 24
;Although an idle code was programmed for channel 17 by the block write
;function above, enabling it for channel 17 would step on the CAS frame
;alignment, and signaling information
Write TCICE4 = FFh ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 25 through 32
Write RCICE1 = FEh ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 2 through 8
Write RCICE2 = FFh ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 9 through 16
Write RCICE3 = FEh ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 18 through 24
Write RCICE4 = FFh ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 25 through 32
97 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IAAR
Register Description:
Register Address:
Idle Array Address Register
7Eh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
GRIC
0
6
GTIC
0
5
IAA5
0
4
IAA4
0
3
IAA3
0
2
IAA2
0
1
IAA1
0
0
IAA0
0
Bits 0 to 5/Channel Pointer Address Bits (IAA0 to IAA5). These bits select the channel to be programmed with
the idle code defined in the PCICR register. IAA0 is the LSB of the 5-bit channel code. Channel 1 is 01h.
Bit 6/Global Transmit-Idle Code (GTIC). Setting this bit causes all transmit channels to be set to the idle code
written to the PCICR register. This bit must be set = 0 for read operations. The value in bits IAA0–IAA5 must be a
valid transmit channel (01h to 20h for E1 mode; 01h to 18h for T1 mode).
Bit 7/Global Receive-Idle Code (GRIC). Setting this bit causes all receive channels to be set to the idle code
written to the PCICR register. This bit must be set = 0 for read operations. The value in bits IAA0–IAA5 must be a
valid transmit channel (01h to 20h for E1 mode; 01h to 18h for T1 mode).
Table 17-B. GRIC and GTIC Functions
GRIC GTIC
FUNCTION
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Updates a single transmit or receive channel
Updates all transmit channels
Updates all receive channels
Updates all transmit and receive channels
Register Name:
PCICR
Register Description:
Register Address:
Per-Channel Idle Code Register
7Fh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Idle-Code Bits (C0 to C7). This register defines the idle code to be programmed in the
channel selected by the IAAR register. C0 is the LSB of the idle code (this bit is transmitted last).
98 of 238
DS2155
The transmit-channel idle-code enable registers (TCICE1/2/3/4) are used to determine which of the 24 T1 or 32 E1
channels from the backplane to the T1 or E1 line should be overwritten with the code placed in the per-channel
code array.
Register Name:
TCICE1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 1
80h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH8
0
6
CH7
0
5
CH6
0
4
CH5
0
3
CH4
0
2
CH3
0
1
CH2
0
0
CH1
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 1 to 8 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH1 to CH8)
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream
Register Name:
TCICE2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 2
81h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH16
0
6
CH15
0
5
CH14
0
4
CH13
0
3
CH12
0
2
CH11
0
1
CH10
0
0
CH9
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 9 to 16 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH9 to CH16)
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the idle code-array into the transmit data stream
Register Name:
TCICE3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 3
82h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH24
0
6
CH23
0
5
CH22
0
4
CH21
0
3
CH20
0
2
CH19
0
1
CH18
0
0
CH17
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 17 to 24 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH17 to CH24)
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the idle code-array into the transmit data stream
Register Name:
TCICE4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 4
83h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH32
0
6
CH31
0
5
CH30
0
4
CH29
0
3
CH28
0
2
CH27
0
1
CH26
0
0
CH25
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 25 to 32 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH25 to CH32)
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream
99 of 238
DS2155
The receive-channel idle-code enable registers (RCICE1/2/3/4) are used to determine which of the 24 T1 or 32 E1
channels from the backplane to the T1 or E1 line should be overwritten with the code placed in the per-channel
code array.
Register Name:
RCICE1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 1
84h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH8
0
6
CH7
0
5
CH6
0
4
CH5
0
3
CH4
0
2
CH3
0
1
CH2
0
0
CH1
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 1 to 8 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH1 to CH8)
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream
Register Name:
RCICE2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 2
85h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH16
0
6
CH15
0
5
CH14
0
4
CH13
0
3
CH12
0
2
CH11
0
1
CH10
0
0
CH9
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 9 to 16 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH9 to CH16)
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream
Register Name:
RCICE3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 3
86h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH24
0
6
CH23
0
5
CH22
0
4
CH21
0
3
CH20
0
2
CH19
0
1
CH18
0
0
CH17
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 17 to 24 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH17 to CH24)
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream
Register Name:
RCICE4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 4
87h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH32
0
6
CH31
0
5
CH30
0
4
CH29
0
3
CH28
0
2
CH27
0
1
CH26
0
0
CH25
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 25 to 32 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH25 to CH32)
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream
100 of 238
DS2155
18. CHANNEL BLOCKING REGISTERS
The receive channel blocking registers (RCBR1/RCBR2/RCBR3/RCBR4) and the transmit channel
blocking registers (TCBR1/TCBR2/TCBR3/TCBR4) control RCHBLK and TCHBLK pins, respectively.
The RCHBLK and TCHBLK pins are user-programmable outputs that can be forced either high or low
during individual channels. These outputs can be used to block clocks to a USART or LAPD controller in
ISDN-PRI applications. When the appropriate bits are set to a 1, the RCHBLK and TCHBLK pins are
held high during the entire corresponding channel time. Channels 25 through 32 are ignored when the
DS2155 is operated in the T1 mode.
Register Name:
RCBR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Channel Blocking Register 1
88h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH8
0
6
CH7
0
5
CH6
0
4
CH5
0
3
CH4
0
2
CH3
0
1
CH2
0
0
CH1
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 1 to 8 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH1 to CH8)
0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time
1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time
Register Name:
RCBR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Channel Blocking Register 2
89h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH16
0
6
CH15
0
5
CH14
0
4
CH13
0
3
CH12
0
2
CH11
0
1
CH10
0
0
CH9
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 9 to 16 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH9 to CH16)
0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time
1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time
101 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RCBR3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Channel Blocking Register 3
8Ah
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH24
0
6
CH23
0
5
CH22
0
4
CH21
0
3
CH20
0
2
CH19
0
1
CH18
0
0
CH17
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 17 to 24 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH17 to CH24)
0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time
1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time
Register Name:
RCBR4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Channel Blocking Register 4
8Bh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH32
0
6
CH31
0
5
CH30
0
4
CH29
0
3
CH28
0
2
CH27
0
1
CH26
0
0
CH25
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 25 to 32 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH25 to CH32)
0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time
1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time
102 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TCBR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 1
8Ch
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH8
0
6
CH7
0
5
CH6
0
4
CH5
0
3
CH4
0
2
CH3
0
1
CH2
0
0
CH1
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 1 to 8 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH1 to CH8)
0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time
1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time
Register Name:
TCBR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 2
8Dh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH16
0
6
CH15
0
5
CH14
0
4
CH13
0
3
CH12
0
2
CH11
0
1
CH10
0
0
CH9
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 9 to 16 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH9 to CH16)
0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time
1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time
Register Name:
TCBR3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 3
8Eh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH24
0
6
CH23
0
5
CH22
0
4
CH21
0
3
CH20
0
2
CH19
0
1
CH18
0
0
CH17
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 17 to 24 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH17 to CH24)
0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time
1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time
Register Name:
TCBR4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 4
8Fh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CH32
0
6
CH31
0
5
CH30
0
4
CH29
0
3
CH28
0
2
CH27
0
1
CH26
0
0
CH25
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 25 to 32 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH25 to CH32)
0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time
1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time
103 of 238
DS2155
19. ELASTIC STORES OPERATION
The DS2155 contains dual two-frame elastic stores, one for the receive direction and one for the transmit
direction. Both elastic stores are fully independent. The transmit and receive-side elastic stores can be
enabled/disabled independently of each other. Also, each elastic store can interface to either a 1.544MHz
or 2.048MHz/4.096MHz/8.192MHz/16.384MHz backplane without regard to the backplane rate the other
elastic store is interfacing to.
The elastic stores have two main purposes. Firstly, they can be used for rate conversion. When the
DS2155 is in the T1 mode, the elastic stores can rate-convert the T1 data stream to a 2.048MHz
backplane. In E1 mode, the elastic store can rate-convert the E1 data stream to a 1.544MHz backplane.
Secondly, they can be used to absorb the differences in frequency and phase between the T1 or E1 data
stream and an asynchronous (i.e., not locked) backplane clock, which can be 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. In
this mode, the elastic stores manage the rate difference and perform controlled slips, deleting or repeating
frames of data in order to manage the difference between the network and the backplane.
The elastic stores can also be used to multiplex T1 or E1 data streams into higher backplane rates, which
is the IBO discussed in Section 28.
104 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
ESCR
Register Description:
Register Address:
Elastic Store Control Register
4Fh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TESALGN TESR TESMDM TESE RESALGN RESR RESMDM RESE
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Enable (RESE)
0 = elastic store is bypassed
1 = elastic store is enabled
Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Minimum-Delay Mode (RESMDM). See Section 19.4 for details.
0 = elastic stores operate at full two-frame depth
1 = elastic stores operate at 32-bit depth
Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Reset (RESR). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 forces the read and write pointers into
opposite frames, maximizing the delay through the receive elastic store. It should be toggled after RSYSCLK has
been applied and is stable. See Section 19.3 for details. Do not leave this bit set HIGH.
Bit 3/Receive Elastic Store Align (RESALGN). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 forces the receive elastic store’s
write/read pointers to a minimum separation of half a frame. No action is taken if the pointer separation is already
greater or equal to half a frame. If pointer separation is less than half a frame, the command is executed and the
data is disrupted. It should be toggled after RSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. Must be cleared and set again
for a subsequent align. See Section 19.3 for details.
Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Enable (TESE)
0 = elastic store is bypassed
1 = elastic store is enabled
Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Minimum-Delay Mode (TESMDM). See Section 19.4 for details.
0 = elastic stores operate at full two-frame depth
1 = elastic stores operate at 32-bit depth
Bit 6/Transmit Elastic Store Reset (TESR). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 forces the read and write pointers into
opposite frames, maximizing the delay through the transmit elastic store. Transmit data is lost during the reset. It
should be toggled after TSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. See Section 19.3 for details. Do not leave this bit
set HIGH.
Bit 7/Transmit Elastic Store Align (TESALGN). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 forces the transmit elastic store’s
write/read pointers to a minimum separation of half a frame. No action is taken if the pointer separation is already
greater or equal to half a frame. If pointer separation is less than half a frame, the command is executed and the
data is disrupted. It should be toggled after TSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. It must be cleared and set
again for a subsequent align. See Section 19.3 for details.
105 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SR5
Register Description:
Register Address:
Status Register 5
1Eh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
TESF
0
4
TESEM
0
3
TSLIP
0
2
RESF
0
1
RESEM
0
0
RSLIP
0
Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Slip-Occurrence Event (RSLIP). Set when the receive elastic store has either
repeated or deleted a frame.
Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Empty Event (RESEM). Set when the receive elastic store buffer empties and a
frame is repeated.
Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Full Event (RESF). Set when the receive elastic store buffer fills and a frame is
deleted.
Bit 3/Transmit Elastic Store Slip-Occurrence Event (TSLIP). Set when the transmit elastic store has either
repeated or deleted a frame.
Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Empty Event (TESEM). Set when the transmit elastic store buffer empties and a
frame is repeated.
Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Full Event (TESF). Set when the transmit elastic store buffer fills and a frame is
deleted.
Register Name:
IMR5
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Mask Register 5
1Fh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
TESF
0
4
TESEM
0
3
TSLIP
0
2
RESF
0
1
RESEM
0
0
RSLIP
0
Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Slip-Occurrence Event (RSLIP)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Empty Event (RESEM)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Full Event (RESF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 3/Transmit Elastic Store Slip-Occurrence Event (TSLIP)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Empty Event (TESEM)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Full Event (TESF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
106 of 238
DS2155
19.1Receive Side
See the IOCR1 and IOCR2 registers for information about clock and I/O configurations.
If the receive-side elastic store is enabled, then the user must provide either a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz
clock at the RSYSCLK pin. For higher rate system clock applications, see the Interleaved PCM Bus
Operation in Section 28. The user has the option of either providing a frame/multiframe sync at the
RSYNC pin or having the RSYNC pin provide a pulse on frame/multiframe boundaries. If signaling
reinsertion is enabled, signaling data in TS16 is realigned to the multiframe sync input on RSYNC.
Otherwise, a multiframe sync input on RSYNC is treated as a simple frame boundary by the elastic store.
The framer always indicates frame boundaries on the network side of the elastic store by the RFSYNC
output, whether the elastic store is enabled or not. Multiframe boundaries are always indicated by the
RMSYNC output. If the elastic store is enabled, then RMSYNC outputs the multiframe boundary on the
backplane side of the elastic store.
19.1.1 T1 Mode
If the user selects to apply a 2.048MHz clock to the RSYSCLK pin, then the data output at RSER is
forced to all 1s every fourth channel and the F-bit is passed into the MSB of TS0. Hence, channels 1 (bits
1–7), 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 [time slots 0 (bits 1–7), 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, and 28] are forced to a 1.
Also, in 2.048MHz applications, the RCHBLK output is forced high during the same channels as the
RSER pin. This is useful in T1-to-E1 conversion applications. If the two-frame elastic buffer either fills
or empties, a controlled slip occurs. If the buffer empties, then a full frame of data is repeated at RSER,
and the SR5.0 and SR5.1 bits are set to a 1. If the buffer fills, then a full frame of data is deleted, and the
SR5.0 and SR5.2 bits are set to a 1.
19.1.2 E1 Mode
If the elastic store is enabled, then either CAS or CRC4 multiframe boundaries are indicated through the
RMSYNC output. If the user selects to apply a 1.544MHz clock to the RSYSCLK pin, then every fourth
channel of the received E1 data is deleted and an F-bit position, which is forced to 1, is inserted. Hence,
channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 (time slots 0, 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, and 28) are deleted from the
received E1 data stream. Also, in 1.544MHz applications, the RCHBLK output is not active in channels
25 through 32 (i.e., RCBR4 is not active). If the two-frame elastic buffer either fills or empties, a
controlled slip occurs. If the buffer empties, then a full frame of data is repeated at RSER, and the SR5.0
and SR5.1 bits are set to a 1. If the buffer fills, then a full frame of data is deleted, and the SR5.0 and
SR5.2 bits are set to a 1.
19.2Transmit Side
See the IOCR1 and IOCR2 registers for information about clock and I/O configurations.
The operation of the transmit elastic store is very similar to the receive side. If the transmit-side elastic
store is enabled, a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock can be applied to the TSYSCLK input. For higher rate
system clock applications, see Interleaved PCM Bus Operation in Section 28. Controlled slips in the
transmit elastic store are reported in the SR5.3 bit, and the direction of the slip is reported in the SR5.4
and SR5.5 bits. If hardware signaling insertion is not enabled, CCR3.7 should be set = 1.
107 of 238
DS2155
19.2.1 T1 Mode
If the user selects to apply a 2.048MHz clock to the TSYSCLK pin, then the data input at TSER is
ignored every fourth channel. Therefore channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 (time slots 0, 4, 8, 12, 16,
20, 24, and 28) are ignored. The user can supply frame or multiframe sync pulse to the TSSYNC input.
Also, in 2.048MHz applications, the TCHBLK output is forced high during the channels ignored by the
framer.
19.2.2 E1 Mode
A 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock can be applied to the TSYSCLK input. The user must supply a frame
sync pulse or a multiframe sync pulse to the TSSYNC input.
19.3Elastic Stores Initialization
There are two elastic store initializations that can be used to improve performance in certain applications,
elastic store reset and elastic store align. Both of these involve the manipulation of the elastic store’s read
and write pointers and are useful primarily in synchronous applications (RSYSCLK/TSYSCLK are
locked to RCLK/TCLK, respectively) (Table 19-A).
Table 19-A. Elastic Store Delay After Initialization
INITIALIZATION
REGISTER BIT
DELAY
Receive Elastic Store Reset
Transmit Elastic Store Reset
Receive Elastic Store Align
Transmit Elastic Store Align
ESCR.2
ESCR.6
ESCR.3
ESCR.7
8 Clocks < Delay < 1 Frame
1 Frame < Delay < 2 Frames
½ Frame < Delay < 1 ½ Frames
½ Frame < Delay < 1 ½ Frames
19.4Minimum Delay Mode
Elastic store minimum delay mode can be used when the elastic store’s system clock is locked to its
network clock (i.e., RCLK locked to RSYSCLK for the receive side and TCLK locked to TSYSCLK for
the transmit side). ESCR.5 and ESCR.1 enable the transmit and receive elastic store minimum delay
modes. When enabled, the elastic stores are forced to a maximum depth of 32 bits instead of the normal
two-frame depth. This feature is useful primarily in applications that interface to a 2.048MHz bus.
Certain restrictions apply when minimum delay mode is used. In addition to the restriction mentioned
above, RSYNC must be configured as an output when the receive elastic store is in minimum delay
mode; TSYNC must be configured as an output when transmit minimum delay mode is enabled. In a
typical application, RSYSCLK and TSYSCLK are locked to RCLK, and RSYNC (frame output mode) is
connected to TSSYNC (frame input mode). All of the slip contention logic in the framer is disabled (since
slips cannot occur). On power-up, after the RSYSCLK and TSYSCLK signals have locked to their
respective network clock signals, the elastic store reset bits (ESCR.2 and ESCR.6) should be toggled
from a 0 to a 1 to ensure proper operation.
108 of 238
DS2155
20. G.706 INTERMEDIATE CRC-4 UPDATING (E1 MODE ONLY)
The DS2155 can implement the G.706 CRC-4 recalculation at intermediate path points. When this mode
is enabled, the data stream presented at TSER already has the FAS/NFAS, CRC multiframe alignment
word, and CRC-4 checksum in time slot 0. The user can modify the Sa bit positions. This change in data
content is used to modify the CRC-4 checksum. This modification, however, does not corrupt any error
information the original CRC-4 checksum may contain. In this mode of operation, TSYNC must be
configured to multiframe mode. The data at TSER must be aligned to the TSYNC signal. If TSYNC is an
input, then the user must assert TSYNC aligned at the beginning of the multiframe relative to TSER. If
TSYNC is an output, the user must multiframe-align the data presented to TSER.
Figure 20-1. CRC-4 Recalculate Method
TPOSO/TNEGO
INSERT
EXTRACT
OLD CRC-4
CODE
NEW CRC-4
CODE
TSER
CRC-4
XOR
MODIFY
Sa BIT
CALCULATOR
+
POSITIONS
NEW Sa BIT
DATA
109 of 238
DS2155
21. T1 BIT-ORIENTED CODE (BOC) CONTROLLER
The DS2155 contains a BOC generator on the transmit side and a BOC detector on the receive side. The
BOC function is available only in T1 mode.
21.1Transmit BOC
Bits 0 to 5 in the TFDL register contain the BOC message to be transmitted. Setting BOCC.0 = 1 causes
the transmit BOC controller to immediately begin inserting the BOC sequence into the FDL bit position.
The transmit BOC controller automatically provides the abort sequence. BOC messages are transmitted as
long as BOCC.0 is set.
Transmit a BOC
1) Write 6-bit code into the TFDL register.
2) Set the SBOC bit in BOCC = 1.
21.2Receive BOC
The receive BOC function is enabled by setting BOCC.4 = 1. The RFDL register now operates as the
receive BOC message and information register. The lower six bits of the RFDL register (BOC message
bits) are preset to all 1s. When the BOC bits change state, the BOC change-of-state indicator, SR8.0,
alerts the host. The host then reads the RFDL register to get the BOC status and message. A change-of-
state occurs when either a new BOC code has been present for a time determined by the receive BOC
filter bits RBF0 and RBF1 in the BOCC register, or a nonvalid code is being received.
Receive a BOC
1) Set integration time through BOCC.1 and BOCC.2.
2) Enable the receive BOC function (BOCC.4 = 1).
3) Enable interrupt (IMR8.0 = 1).
4) Wait for interrupt to occur.
5) Read the RFDL register.
6) If SR2.7 = 1, then a valid BOC message was received.
– The lower six bits of the RFDL register comprise the message.
110 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
BOCC
Register Description:
Register Address:
BOC Control Register
37h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
RBOCE
0
3
RBR
0
2
RBF1
0
1
RBF0
0
0
SBOC
0
Bit 0/Send BOC (SBOC). Set = 1 to transmit the BOC code placed in bits 0 to 5 of the TFDL register.
Bits 1 and 2/Receive BOC Filter Bits (RBF0, RBF1). The BOC filter sets the number of consecutive patterns that
must be received without error prior to an indication of a valid message.
Consecutive BOC Codes for
RBF1
RBF0
Valid Sequence Identification
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
None
3
5
7
Bit 3/Receive BOC Reset (RBR). A 0-to-1 transition resets the BOC circuitry. Must be cleared and set again for a
subsequent reset.
Bit 4/Receive BOC Enable (RBOCE). Enables the receive BOC function. The RFDL register reports the received
BOC code and two information bits when this bit is set.
0 = receive BOC function disabled
1 = receive BOC function enabled; the RFDL register reports BOC messages and information
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Register Name:
RFDL
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive FDL Register
C0h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
RBOC5 RBOC4 RBOC3 RBOC2 RBOC1 RBOC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RFDL register bit definitions when BOCC.4 = 1:
Bit 0/BOC Bit 0 (RBOC0)
Bit 1/BOC Bit 1 (RBOC1)
Bit 2/BOC Bit 2 (RBOC2)
Bit 3/BOC Bit 3 (RBOC3)
Bit 4/BOC Bit 4 (RBOC4)
Bit 5/BOC Bit 5 (RBOC5)
Bits 6, 7/This bit position is unused when BOCC.4 = 1.
111 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SR8
Register Description:
Register Address:
Status Register 8
24h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
BOCC RFDLAD RFDLF TFDLE RMTCH RBOC
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive BOC Detector Change-of-State Event (RBOC). Set whenever the BOC detector sees a change of
state to a valid BOC. The setting of this bit prompts the user to read the RFDL register.
Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Event (RMTCH). Set whenever the contents of the RFDL register matches RFDLM1
or RFDLM2.
Bit 2/TFDL Register Empty Event (TFDLE). Set when the transmit FDL buffer (TFDL) empties.
Bit 3/RFDL Register Full Event (RFDLF). Set when the receive FDL buffer (RFDL) fills to capacity.
Bit 4/RFDL Abort Detect Event (RFDLAD). Set when eight consecutive 1s are received on the FDL.
Bit 5/BOC Clear Event (BOCC). Set when 30 FDL bits occur without an abort sequence.
Register Name:
IMR8
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Mask Register 8
25h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
BOCC
0
4
RFDLAD
0
3
RFDLF
0
2
1
0
RBOC
0
TFDLE RMTCH
0
0
Bit 0/Receive BOC Detector Change-of-State Event (RBOC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Event (RMTCH)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 2/TFDL Register Empty Event (TFDLE)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 3/RFDL Register Full Event (RFDLF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 4/RFDL Abort Detect Event (RFDLAD)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 5/BOC Clear Event (BOCC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
112 of 238
DS2155
22. ADDITIONAL (SA) AND INTERNATIONAL (SI) BIT OPERATION (E1
ONLY)
When operated in the E1 mode, the DS2155 provides three methods for accessing the Sa and the Si bits.
The first method involves a hardware scheme that uses the RLINK/RLCLK and TLINK/TLCLK pins
(Section 22.1). The second method involves using the internal RAF/RNAF and TAF/TNAF registers
(Section 22.2). The third method, which is covered in Section 22.3, involves an expanded version of the
second method.
22.1Method 1: Hardware Scheme
On the receive side, all of the received data is reported at the RLINK pin. Using the E1RCR2 register, the
user can control the RLCLK pin to pulse during any combination of Sa bits. This allows the user to create
a clock that can be used to capture the needed Sa bits. If RSYNC is programmed to output a frame
boundary, it identifies the Si bits.
On the transmit side, the individual Sa bits can be either sourced from the internal TNAF register (Section
22.2) or externally from the TLINK pin. Using the E1TCR2 register, the framer can be programmed to
source any combination of the Sa bits from the TLINK pin. Si bits can be sampled through the TSER pin
if by setting E1TCR1.4 = 0.
22.2Method 2: Internal Register Scheme Based on Double-Frame
On the receive side, the RAF and RNAF registers always report the data as it received in the Sa and Si bit
locations. The RAF and RNAF registers are updated on align-frame boundaries. The setting of the receive
align frame bit in Status Register 4 (SR4.0) indicates that the contents of the RAF and RNAF have been
updated. The host can use the SR4.0 bit to know when to read the RAF and RNAF registers. The host has
250µs to retrieve the data before it is lost.
On the transmit side, data is sampled from the TAF and TNAF registers with the setting of the transmit
align frame bit in Status Register 4 (SR4.3). The host can use the SR4.3 bit to know when to update the
TAF and TNAF registers. It has 250µs to update the data or else the old data is retransmitted. If the TAF
and TNAF registers are only being used to source the align frame and nonalign frame-sync
patterns, then the host need only write once to these registers. Data in the Si bit position is
overwritten if either the framer is (1) programmed to source the Si bits from the TSER pin, (2) in the
CRC4 mode, or (3) has automatic E-bit insertion enabled. Data in the Sa bit position is overwritten if any
of the E1TCR2.3 to E1TCR2.7 bits are set to 1.
113 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RAF
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Align Frame Register
C6h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Si
0
6
0
0
5
0
0
4
1
0
3
1
0
2
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
Bit 0/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 1/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 2/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 3/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 4/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 5/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 6/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 7/International Bit (Si)
Register Name:
RNAF
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Nonalign Frame Register
C7h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Si
0
6
1
0
5
A
0
4
Sa4
0
3
Sa5
0
2
Sa6
0
1
Sa7
0
0
Sa8
0
Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 (Sa8)
Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 (Sa7)
Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 (Sa6)
Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 (Sa5)
Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 (Sa4)
Bit 5/Remote Alarm (A)
Bit 6/Frame Nonalignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 7/International Bit (Si)
114 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TAF
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Align Frame Register
D0h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Si
0
6
0
0
5
0
0
4
1
1
3
1
1
2
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
Bit 0/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 1/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 2/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 3/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 4/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 5/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 6/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 7/International Bit (Si)
Register Name:
TNAF
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Nonalign Frame Register
D1h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Si
0
6
1
1
5
A
0
4
Sa4
0
3
Sa5
0
2
Sa6
0
1
Sa7
0
0
Sa8
0
Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 (Sa8)
Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 (Sa7)
Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 (Sa6)
Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 (Sa5)
Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 (Sa4)
Bit 5/Remote Alarm [used to transmit the alarm (A)]
Bit 6/Frame Nonalignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 7/International Bit (Si)
115 of 238
DS2155
22.3 Method 3: Internal Register Scheme Based on CRC4 Multiframe
The receive side contains a set of eight registers (RSiAF, RSiNAF, RRA, and RSa4–RSa8) that report the
Si and Sa bits as they are received. These registers are updated with the setting of the receive CRC4
multiframe bit in Status Register 2 (SR4.1). The host can use the SR4.1 bit to know when to read these
registers. The user has 2ms to retrieve the data before it is lost. The MSB of each register is the first
received. See the following register descriptions for more details.
The transmit side also contains a set of eight registers (TSiAF, TSiNAF, TRA, and TSa4–TSa8) that,
through the transmit Sa bit control register (TSaCR), can be programmed to insert Si and Sa data. Data is
sampled from these registers with the setting of the transmit multiframe bit in Status Register 2 (SR4.4).
The host can use the SR4.4 bit to know when to update these registers. It has 2ms to update the data or
else the old data is retransmitted. The MSB of each register is the first bit transmitted. See the following
register descriptions for more details.
Register Name:
RSiAF
Register Description:
Register Address:
Received Si Bits of the Align Frame
C8h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
SiF0
0
6
SiF2
0
5
SiF4
0
4
SiF6
0
3
SiF8
0
2
SiF10
0
1
SiF12
0
0
SiF14
0
Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 14 (SiF14)
Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 12 (SiF12)
Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 10 (SiF10)
Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 8 (SiF8)
Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 6 (SiF6)
Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 4 (SiF4)
Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 2 (SiF2)
Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 0 (SiF0)
116 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RSiNAF
Register Description:
Register Address:
Received Si Bits of the Nonalign Frame
C9h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
SiF1
0
6
SiF3
0
5
SiF5
0
4
SiF7
0
3
SiF9
0
2
SiF11
0
1
SiF13
0
0
SiF15
0
Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 15 (SiF15)
Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 13 (SiF13)
Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 11 (SiF11)
Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 9 (SiF9)
Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 7 (SiF7)
Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 5 (SiF5)
Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 3 (SiF3)
Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 1 (SiF1)
Register Name:
RRA
Register Description:
Register Address:
Received Remote Alarm
Cah
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
RRAF5
0
4
3
2
1
0
RRAF1 RRAF3
RRAF7 RRAF9 RRAF11 RRAF13 RRAF15
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 15 (RRAF15)
Bit 1/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 13 (RRAF13)
Bit 2/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 11 (RRAF11)
Bit 3/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 9 (RRAF9)
Bit 4/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 7 (RRAF7)
Bit 5/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 5 (RRAF5)
Bit 6/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 3 (RRAF3)
Bit 7/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 1 (RRAF1)
117 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RSa4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Received Sa4 Bits
CBh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa4F1
0
6
RSa4F3
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSa4F5 RSa4F7 RSa4F9 RSa4F11 RSa4F13 RSa4F15
0 0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa4 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa4F15)
Bit 1/Sa4 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa4F13)
Bit 2/Sa4 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa4F11)
Bit 3/Sa4 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa4F9)
Bit 4/Sa4 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa4F7)
Bit 5/Sa4 Bit of Frame 5(RSa4F5)
Bit 6/Sa4 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa4F3)
Bit 7/Sa4 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa4F1)
Register Name:
RSa5
Register Description:
Register Address:
Received Sa5 Bits
CCh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa5F1
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSa5F3 RSa5F5 RSa5F7 RSa5F9 RSa5F11 RSa5F13 RSa5F15
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa5 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa5F15)
Bit 1/Sa5 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa5F13)
Bit 2/Sa5 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa5F11)
Bit 3/Sa5 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa5F9)
Bit 4/Sa5 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa5F7)
Bit 5/Sa5 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa5F5)
Bit 6/Sa5 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa5F3)
Bit 7/Sa5 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa5F1)
118 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RSa6
Register Description:
Register Address:
Received Sa6 Bits
CDh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa6F1
0
6
RSa6F3
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSa6F5 RSa6F7 RSa6F9 RSa6F11 RSa6F13 RSa6F15
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa6 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa6F15)
Bit 1/Sa6 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa6F13)
Bit 2/Sa6 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa6F11)
Bit 3/Sa6 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa6F9)
Bit 4/Sa6 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa6F7)
Bit 5/Sa6 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa6F5)
Bit 6/Sa6 Bit of Frame 4 (RSa6F4)
Bit 7/Sa6 Bit of Frame 3(RSa6F3)
Register Name:
RSa7
Register Description:
Register Address:
Received Sa7 Bits
CEh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa7F1
0
6
Rsa7F3
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSa7F5 RSa7F7 RSa7F9 RSa7F11 RSa7F13 RSa7F15
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa7 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa7F15)
Bit 1/Sa7 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa7F13)
Bit 2/Sa7 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa7F11)
Bit 3/Sa7 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa7F9)
Bit 4/Sa7 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa7F7)
Bit 5/Sa7 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa7F5)
Bit 6/Sa7 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa7F3)
Bit 7/Sa7 Bit of Frame 1(RSa4F1)
119 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RSa8
Register Description:
Register Address:
Received Sa8 Bits
CFh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa8F1
0
6
RSa8F3
0
5
RSa8F5
0
4
RSa8F7
0
3
2
1
0
RSa8F9 RSa8F11 RSa8F13 RSa8F15
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa8 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa8F15)
Bit 1/Sa8 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa8F13)
Bit 2/Sa8 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa8F11)
Bit 3/Sa8 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa8F9)
Bit 4/Sa8 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa8F7)
Bit 5/Sa8 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa8F5)
Bit 6/Sa8 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa8F3)
Bit 7/Sa8 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa8F1)
Register Name:
TSiAF
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Si Bits of the Align Frame
D2h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSiF0
0
6
TSiF2
0
5
TSiF4
0
4
TSiF6
0
3
TSiF8
0
2
1
0
TSiF10 TSiF12
TSiF14
0
0
0
Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 14 (TSiF14)
Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 12 (TSiF12)
Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 10 (TSiF10)
Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 8 (TSiF8)
Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 6 (TSiF6)
Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 4 (TSiF4)
Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 2 (TSiF2)
Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 0 (TSiF0)
120 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TSiNAF
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Si Bits of the Nonalign Frame
D3h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSiF1
0
6
TSiF3
0
5
TSiF5
0
4
TSiF7
0
3
TSiF9
0
2
1
0
TSiF15
0
TSiF11 TSiF13
0
0
Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 15 (TSiF15)
Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 13 (TSiF13)
Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 11 (TSiF11)
Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 9 (TSiF9)
Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 7 (TSiF7)
Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 5 (TSiF5)
Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 3 (TSiF3)
Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 1 (TSiF1)
Register Name:
TRA
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Remote Alarm
D4h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TRAF1
0
6
TRAF3
0
5
TRAF5
0
4
3
2
1
0
TRAF7 TRAF9 TRAF11 TRAF13 TRAF15
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 15 (TRAF15)
Bit 1/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 13 (TRAF13)
Bit 2/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 11 (TRAF11)
Bit 3/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 9 (TRAF9)
Bit 4/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 7 (TRAF7)
Bit 5/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 5 (TRAF5)
Bit 6/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 3 (TRAF3)
Bit 7/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 1 (TRAF1)
121 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TSa4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Sa4 Bits
D5h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa4F1
0
6
TSa4F3
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSa4F5 TSa4F7 TSa4F9 TSa4F11 TSa4F13 TSa4F15
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa4 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa4F15)
Bit 1/Sa4 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa4F13)
Bit 2/Sa4 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa4F11)
Bit 3/Sa4 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa4F9)
Bit 4/Sa4 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa4F7)
Bit 5/Sa4 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa4F5)
Bit 6/Sa4 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa4F3)
Bit 7/Sa4 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa4F1)
Register Name:
TSa5
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmitted Sa5 Bits
D6h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa5F1
0
6
TSa5F3
0
5
TSa5F5
0
4
3
TSa5F9
0
2
1
0
TSa5F7
0
TSa5F11 TSa5F13
TSa5F15
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa5 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa5F15)
Bit 1/Sa5 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa5F13)
Bit 2/Sa5 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa5F11)
Bit 3/Sa5 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa5F9)
Bit 4/Sa5 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa5F7)
Bit 5/Sa5 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa5F5)
Bit 6/Sa5 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa5F3)
Bit 7/Sa5 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa5F1)
122 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TSa6
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Sa6 Bits
D7h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa6F1
0
6
TSa6F3
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSa6F5 TSa6F7 TSa6F9 TSa6F11 TSa6F13 TSa6F15
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa6 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa6F15)
Bit 1/Sa6 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa6F13)
Bit 2/Sa6 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa6F11)
Bit 3/Sa6 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa6F9)
Bit 4/Sa6 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa6F7)
Bit 5/Sa6 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa6F5)
Bit 6/Sa6 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa6F3)
Bit 7/Sa6 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa6F1)
Register Name:
TSa7
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Sa7 Bits
D8h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa7F1
0
6
TSa7F3
0
5
TSa7F5
0
4
3
2
1
0
TSa7F7 TSa7F9 TSa7F11 TSa7F13 TSa7F15
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa7 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa7F15)
Bit 1/Sa7 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa7F13)
Bit 2/Sa7 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa7F11)
Bit 3/Sa7 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa7F9)
Bit 4/Sa7 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa7F7)
Bit 5/Sa7 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa7F5)
Bit 6/Sa7 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa7F3)
Bit 7/Sa7 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa4F1)
123 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TSa8
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Sa8 Bits
D9h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa8F1
0
6
TSa8F3
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSa8F5 TSa8F7 TSa8F9 TSa8F11 TSa8F13 TSa8F15
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa8 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa8F15)
Bit 1/Sa8 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa8F13)
Bit 2/Sa8 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa8F11)
Bit 3/Sa8 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa8F9)
Bit 4/Sa8 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa8F7)
Bit 5/Sa8 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa8F5)
Bit 6/Sa8 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa8F3)
Bit 7/Sa8 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa8F1)
124 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TSACR
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Sa Bit Control Register
DAh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
SiAF
0
6
SiNAF
0
5
RA
0
4
Sa4
0
3
Sa5
0
2
Sa6
0
1
Sa7
0
0
Sa8
0
Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 Insertion Control Bit (Sa8)
0 = do not insert data from the TSa8 register into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the TSa8 register into the transmit data stream
Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 Insertion Control Bit (Sa7)
0 = do not insert data from the TSa7 register into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the TSa7 register into the transmit data stream
Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 Insertion Control Bit (Sa6)
0 = do not insert data from the TSa6 register into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the TSa6 register into the transmit data stream
Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 Insertion Control Bit (Sa5)
0 = do not insert data from the TSa5 register into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the TSa5 register into the transmit data stream
Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 Insertion Control Bit (Sa4)
0 = do not insert data from the TSa4 register into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the TSa4 register into the transmit data stream
Bit 5/Remote Alarm Insertion Control Bit (RA)
0 = do not insert data from the TRA register into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the TRA register into the transmit data stream
Bit 6/International Bit in Nonalign Frame Insertion Control Bit (SiNAF)
0 = do not insert data from the TSiNAF register into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the TSiNAF register into the transmit data stream
Bit 7/International Bit in Align Frame Insertion Control Bit (SiAF)
0 = do not insert data from the TSiAF register into the transmit data stream
1 = insert data from the TSiAF register into the transmit data stream
125 of 238
DS2155
23. HDLC CONTROLLERS
This device has two enhanced HDLC controllers, HDLC #1 and HDLC #2. Each controller is
configurable for use with time slots, Sa4 to Sa8 bits (E1 mode), or the FDL (T1 mode). Each HDLC
controller has 128-byte buffers in the transmit and receive paths. When used with time slots, the user can
select any time slot or multiple time slots, contiguous or noncontiguous, as well as any specific bits
within the time slot(s) to assign to the HDLC controllers.
The user must not map both transmit HDLC controllers to the same Sa bits, time slots or, in T1 mode,
map both controllers to the FDL. HDLC #1 and HDLC #2 are identical in operation and therefore the
following operational description refers only to a singular controller.
The HDLC controller performs the entire necessary overhead for generating and receiving performance
report messages (PRMs) as described in ANSI T1.403 and the messages as described in AT&T TR54016.
The HDLC controller automatically generates and detects flags, generates and checks the CRC check
sum, generates and detects abort sequences, stuffs and destuffs zeros, and byte aligns to the data stream.
The 128-byte buffers in the HDLC controller are large enough to allow a full PRM to be received or
transmitted without host intervention.
23.1 Basic Operation Details
The HDLC registers are divided into four groups: control/configuration, status/information, mapping, and
FIFOs. Table 23-A lists these registers by group.
23.2 HDLC Configuration
The HxTC and HxRC registers perform the basic configuration of the HDLC controllers. Operating
features such as CRC generation, zero stuffer, transmit and receive HDLC mapping options, and idle
flags are selected here. These registers also reset the HDLC controllers.
126 of 238
DS2155
Table 23-A. HDLC Controller Registers
REGISTER
FUNCTION
CONTROL AND CONFIGURATION
H1TC, HDLC #1 Transmit Control Register
H2TC, HDLC #2 Transmit Control Register
H1RC, HDLC #1 Receive Control Register
H2RC, HDLC #2 Receive Control Register
H1FC, HDLC #1 FIFO Control Register
H2FC, HDLC #2 FIFO Control Register
General control over the transmit HDLC
controllers
General control over the receive HDLC
controllers
Sets high watermark for receiver and low
watermark for transmitter
STATUS AND INFORMATION
SR6, HDLC #1 Status Register
Key status information for both transmit and
receive directions
SR7, HDLC #2 Status Register
IMR6, HDLC #1 Interrupt Mask Register
IMR7, HDLC #2 Interrupt Mask Register
INFO4, HDLC #1 and #2 Information Register
INFO5, HDLC #1 Information Register
INFO6, HDLC #2 Information Register
H1RPBA, HDLC #1 Receive Packet Bytes
Available Register
Selects which bits in the status registers (SR7
and SR8) cause interrupts
Information about HDLC controller
Indicates the number of bytes that can be read
from the receive FIFO
H2RPBA, HDLC #2 Receive Packet Bytes
Available Register
H1TFBA, HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Buffer
Available Register
Indicates the number of bytes that can be
written to the transmit FIFO
H2TFBA, HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Buffer
Available Register
MAPPING
H1RCS1, H1RCS2, H1RCS3, H1RCS4, HDLC Selects which channels are mapped to the
#1 Receive Channel Select Registers
H2RCS1, H2RCS2, H2RCS3, H2RCS4, HDLC
#2 Receive Channel Select Registers
H1RTSBS, HDLC #1 Receive TS/Sa Bit Select
Register
receive HDLC controller
Selects which bits in a channel are used or
which Sa bits are used by the receive HDLC
controller
H2RTSBS, HDLC #2 Receive TS/Sa Bit Select
Register
H1TCS1, H1TCS2, H1TCS3, H1TCS4, HDLC
#1 Transmit Channel Select Registers
H2TCS1, H2TCS2, H2TCS3, H2TCS4, HDLC
#2 Transmit Channel Select Registers
Selects which channels are mapped to the
transmit HDLC controller
H1TTSBS, HDLC # 1 Transmit TS/Sa Bit Select Selects which bits in a channel are used or
Register
which Sa bits are used by the transmit HDLC
H2TTSBS, HDLC # 2 Transmit TS/Sa Bit Select controller
Register
FIFOs
H1RF, HDLC #1 Receive FIFO Register
H2RF, HDLC #1 Receive FIFO Register
H1TF, HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Register
H2TF, HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Register
Access to 128-byte receive FIFO
Access to 128-byte transmit FIFO
127 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
H1TC, H2TC
Register Description:
HDLC #1 Transmit Control
HDLC #2 Transmit Control
90h, A0h
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
THR
0
4
THMS
0
3
TFS
0
2
TEOM
0
1
TZSD
0
0
TCRCD
0
NOFS TEOML
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit CRC Defeat (TCRCD). A 2-byte CRC code is automatically appended to the outbound message.
This bit can be used to disable the CRC function.
0 = enable CRC generation (normal operation)
1 = disable CRC generation
Bit 1/Transmit Zero-Stuffer Defeat (TZSD). The zero-stuffer function automatically inserts a 0 in the message
field (between the flags) after five consecutive 1s to prevent the emulation of a flag or abort sequence by the data
pattern. The receiver automatically removes (destuffs) any 0 after five 1s in the message field.
0 = enable the zero stuffer (normal operation)
1 = disable the zero stuffer
Bit 2/Transmit End of Message (TEOM). Should be set to a 1 just before the last data byte of an HDLC packet is
written into the transmit FIFO at HxTF. If not disabled through TCRCD, the transmitter automatically appends a 2-
byte CRC code to the end of the message.
Bit 3/Transmit Flag/Idle Select (TFS). This bit selects the intermessage fill character after the closing and before
the opening flags (7Eh).
0 = 7Eh
1 = FFh
Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Mapping Select (THMS)
0 = transmit HDLC assigned to channels
1 = transmit HDLC assigned to FDL (T1 mode), Sa bits (E1 mode)
Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Reset (THR). Resets the transmit HDLC controller and flushes the transmit FIFO. An
abort followed by 7Eh or FFh flags/idle is transmitted until a new packet is initiated by writing new data into the
FIFO. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent reset.
0 = normal operation
1 = reset transmit HDLC controller and flush the transmit FIFO
Bit 6/Transmit End of Message and Loop (TEOML). To loop on a message, this bit should be set to a 1 just
before the last data byte of an HDLC packet is written into the transmit FIFO. The message repeats until the user
clears this bit or a new message is written to the transmit FIFO. If the host clears the bit, the looping message
completes, then flags are transmitted until a new message is written to the FIFO. If the host terminates the loop by
writing a new message to the FIFO, the loop terminates, one or two flags are transmitted, and the new message
starts. If not disabled through TCRCD, the transmitter automatically appends a 2-byte CRC code to the end of all
messages. This is useful for transmitting consecutive SS7 FISUs without host intervention.
Bit 7/Number of Flags Select (NOFS)
0 = send one flag between consecutive messages
1 = send two flags between consecutive messages
128 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
H1RC, H2RC
Register Description:
HDLC #1 Receive Control
HDLC #2 Receive Control
31h, 32h
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RHR
0
6
RHMS
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
—
0
0
RSFD
0
Bit 0/Receive SS7 Fill-In Signal Unit Delete (RSFD)
0 = normal operation; all FISUs are stored in the receive FIFO and reported to the host.
1 = When a consecutive FISU having the same BSN the previous FISU is detected, it is deleted without
host intervention.
Bits 1 to 5/Unused, must be set to 0 or proper operation
Bit 6/Receive HDLC Mapping Select (RHMS)
0 = receive HDLC assigned to channels
1 = receive HDLC assigned to FDL (T1 mode), Sa bits (E1 mode)
Bit 7/Receive HDLC Reset (RHR). Resets the receive HDLC controller and flushes the receive FIFO. Must be
cleared and set again for a subsequent reset.
0 = normal operation
1 = reset receive HDLC controller and flush the receive FIFO
129 of 238
DS2155
23.2.1 FIFO Control
The FIFO control register (HxFC) controls and sets the watermarks for the transmit and receive FIFOs.
Bits 3, 4, and 5 set the transmit low watermark and the lower 3 bits set the receive high watermark.
When the transmit FIFO empties below the low watermark, the TLWM bit in the appropriate HDLC
status register SR6 or SR7 is set. TLWM is a real-time bit and remains set as long as the transmit FIFO’s
read pointer is below the watermark. If enabled, this condition can also cause an interrupt through the INT
pin.
When the receive FIFO fills above the high watermark, the RHWM bit in the appropriate HDLC status
register is set. RHWM is a real-time bit and remains set as long as the receive FIFO’s write pointer is
above the watermark. If enabled, this condition can also cause an interrupt through the INT pin.
Register Name:
H1FC, H2FC
Register Description:
HDLC # 1 FIFO Control
HDLC # 2 FIFO Control
91h, A1h
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
TFLWM2
0
4
3
2
1
0
TFLWM1
0
TFLWM0 RFHWM2 RFHWM1 RFHWM0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Receive FIFO High-Watermark Select (RFHWM0 to RFHWM2)
Receive FIFO Watermark
RFHWM2 RFHWM1 RFHWM0
(bytes)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
4
16
32
48
64
80
96
112
Bits 3 to 5/Transmit FIFO Low-Watermark Select (TFLWM0 to TFLWM2)
Transmit FIFO Watermark
TFLWM2
TFLWM1
TFLWM0
(bytes)
4
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
16
32
48
64
80
96
112
Bits 6, 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
130 of 238
DS2155
23.3HDLC Mapping
23.3.1 Receive
The HDLC controllers must be assigned a space in the T1/E1 bandwidth in which they transmit and
receive data. The controllers can be mapped to either the FDL (T1), Sa bits (E1), or to channels. If
mapped to channels, then any channel or combination of channels, contiguous or not, can be assigned to
an HDLC controller. When assigned to a channel(s), any combination of bits within the channel(s) can be
avoided.
The HxRCS1–HxRCS4 registers are used to assign the receive controllers to channels 1–24 (T1) or
1–32 (E1) according to the following table:
Register
Channels
HxRCS1
HxRCS2
HxRCS3
HxRCS4
1–8
9–16
17–24
25–32
Register Name:
H1RCS1, H1RCS2, H1RCS3, H1RCS4
H2RCS1, H2RCS2, H2RCS3, H2RCS4
HDLC # 1 Receive Channel Select x
HDLC # 2 Receive Channel Select x
92h, 93h, 94h, 95h
Register Description:
Register Address:
A2h, A3h, A4h, A5h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RHCS0
0
RHCS7 RHCS6 RHCS5 RHCS4 RHCS3 RHCS2 RHCS1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 0 (RHCS0). Select Channel 1, 9, 17, or 25.
Bit 1/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 1 (RHCS1). Select Channel 2, 10, 18, or 26.
Bit 2/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 2 (RHCS2). Select Channel 3, 11, 19, or 27.
Bit 3/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 3 (RHCS3). Select Channel 4, 12, 20, or 28.
Bit 4/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 4 (RHCS4). Select Channel 5, 13, 21, or 29.
Bit 5/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 5 (RHCS5). Select Channel 6, 14, 22, or 30.
Bit 6/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 6 (RHCS6). Select Channel 7, 15, 23, or 31.
Bit 7/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 7 (RHCS7). Select Channel 8, 16, 24, or 32.
131 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
H1RTSBS, H2RTSBS
Register Description:
HDLC # 1 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select
HDLC # 2 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select
96h, A6h
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
RCB4SE
0
2
1
0
RCB8SE RCB7SE RCB6SE RCB5SE
RCB3SE RCB2SE RCB1SE
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Channel Bit 1 Suppress Enable/Sa8 Bit Enable (RCB1SE ). LSB of the channel. Set to 1 to stop
this bit from being used.
Bit 1/Receive Channel Bit 2 Suppress Enable/Sa7 Bit Enable (RCB2SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 2/Receive Channel Bit 3 Suppress Enable/Sa6 Bit Enable (RCB3SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 3/Receive Channel Bit 4 Suppress Enable/Sa5 Bit Enable (RCB4SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 4/Receive Channel Bit 5 Suppress Enable/Sa4 Bit Enable (RCB5SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 5/Receive Channel Bit 6 Suppress Enable (RCB6SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 6/Receive Channel Bit 7 Suppress Enable (RCB7SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 7/Receive Channel Bit 8 Suppress Enable (RCB8SE). MSB of the channel. Set to 1 to stop this bit from
being used.
132 of 238
DS2155
23.3.2 Transmit
The HxTCS1–HxTCS4 registers are used to assign the transmit controllers to channels 1–24 (T1) or
1–32 (E1) according to the following table.
Register
Channels
HxTCS1
HxTCS2
HxTCS3
HxTCS4
1–8
9–16
17–24
25–32
Register Name:
H1TCS1, H1TCS2, H1TCS3, H1TCS4
H2TCS1, H2TCS2, H2TCS3, H2TCS4
HDLC # 1 Transmit Channel Select
HDLC # 2 Transmit Channel Select
97h, 98h, 99h, 9Ah
Register Description:
Register Address:
A7h, A8h, A9h, AAh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
THCS7 THCS6 THCS5 THCS4 THCS3
THCS2 THCS1 THCS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 0 (THCS0). Select Channel 1, 9, 17, or 25.
Bit 1/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 1 (THCS1). Select Channel 2, 10, 18, or 26.
Bit 2/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 2 (THCS2). Select Channel 3, 11, 19, or 27.
Bit 3/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 3 (THCS3). Select Channel 4, 12, 20, or 28.
Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 4 (THCS4). Select Channel 5, 13, 21, or 29.
Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 5 (THCS5). Select Channel 6, 14, 22, or 30.
Bit 6/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 6 (THCS6). Select Channel 7, 15, 23, or 31.
Bit 7/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 7 (THCS7). Select Channel 8, 16, 24, or 32.
133 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
H1TTSBS, H2TTSBS
Register Description:
HDLC # 1 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select
HDLC # 2 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select
9Bh, ABh
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TCB8SE TCB7SE TCB6SE TCB5SE TCB4SE TCB3SE TCB2SE TCB1SE
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit Channel Bit 1 Suppress Enable/Sa8 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). LSB of the channel. Set to 1 to stop
this bit from being used.
Bit 1/Transmit Channel Bit 2 Suppress Enable/Sa7 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 2/Transmit Channel Bit 3 Suppress Enable/Sa6 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 3/Transmit Channel Bit 4 Suppress Enable/Sa5 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 4/Transmit Channel Bit 5 Suppress Enable/Sa4 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 5/Transmit Channel Bit 6 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 6/Transmit Channel Bit 7 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 7/Transmit Channel Bit 8 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). MSB of the channel. Set to 1 to stop this bit from
being used.
134 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SR6, SR7
Register Description:
HDLC #1 Status Register 6
HDLC #2 Status Register 7
20h, 22h
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
TMEND
0
5
RPE
0
4
RPS
0
3
RHWM
0
2
RNE
0
1
TLWM
0
0
TNF
0
Bit 0/Transmit FIFO Not Full Condition (TNF). Set when the transmit 128-byte FIFO has at least 1 byte
available.
Bit 1/Transmit FIFO Below Low-Watermark Condition (TLWM). Set when the transmit 128-byte FIFO
empties beyond the low watermark as defined by the transmit low-watermark register (TLWMR).
Bit 2/Receive FIFO Not Empty Condition (RNE). Set when the receive 128-byte FIFO has at least 1 byte
available for a read.
Bit 3/Receive FIFO Above High-Watermark Condition (RHWM). Set when the receive 128-byte FIFO fills
beyond the high watermark as defined by the receive high-watermark register (RHWMR).
Bit 4/Receive Packet-Start Event (RPS). Set when the HDLC controller detects an opening byte. This is a latched
bit and is cleared when read.
Bit 5/Receive Packet-End Event (RPE). Set when the HDLC controller detects either the finish of a valid
message (i.e., CRC check complete) or when the controller has experienced a message fault such as a CRC
checking error, or an overrun condition, or an abort has been seen. This is a latched bit and is cleared when read.
Bit 6/Transmit Message-End Event (TMEND). Set when the transmit HDLC controller has finished sending a
message. This is a latched bit and is cleared when read.
135 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IMR6, IMR7
Register Description:
HDLC # 1 Interrupt Mask Register 6
HDLC # 2 Interrupt Mask Register 7
21h, 23h
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
TMEND
0
5
RPE
0
4
RPS
0
3
RHWM
0
2
RNE
0
1
TLWM
0
0
TNF
0
Bit 0/Transmit FIFO Not Full Condition (TNF)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only
Bit 1/Transmit FIFO Below Low-Watermark Condition (TLWM)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only
Bit 2/Receive FIFO Not Empty Condition (RNE)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only
Bit 3/Receive FIFO Above High-Watermark Condition (RHWM)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only
Bit 4/Receive Packet-Start Event (RPS)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 5/Receive Packet-End Event (RPE)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 6/Transmit Message-End Event (TMEND)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
136 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
INFO5, INFO6
Register Description:
HDLC #1 Information Register
HDLC #2 Information Register
2Eh, 2Fh
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
TEMPTY
0
4
TFULL
0
3
REMPTY
0
2
PS2
0
1
PS1
0
0
PS0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Receive Packet Status (PS0 to PS2). These are real-time bits indicating the status as of the last read of
the receive FIFO.
PS2
PS1
PS0
Packet Status
0
0
0
In Progress
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
Packet OK: Packet ended with correct CRC codeword
CRC Error: A closing flag was detected, preceded by a corrupt CRC
codeword
Abort: Packet ended because an abort signal was detected (seven or
more 1s in a row).
Overrun: HDLC controller terminated reception of packet because
receive FIFO is full.
Bit 3/Receive FIFO Empty (REMPTY). A real-time bit that is set high when the receive FIFO is empty.
Bit 4/Transmit FIFO Full (TFULL). A real-time bit that is set high when the FIFO is full.
Bit 5/Transmit FIFO Empty (TEMPTY). A real-time bit that is set high when the FIFO is empty.
Register Name:
INFO4
Register Description:
Register Address:
HDLC Event Information Register #4
2Dh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
2
1
0
H2UDR H2OBT H1UDR H1OBT
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/HDLC #1 Opening Byte Event (H1OBT). Set when the next byte available in the receive FIFO is the first
byte of a message.
Bit 1/HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Underrun Event (H1UDR). Set when the transmit FIFO empties out without
having seen the TMEND bit set. An abort is automatically sent. This bit is latched and is cleared when read.
Bit 2/HDLC #2 Opening Byte Event (H2OBT). Set when the next byte available in the receive FIFO is the first
byte of a message.
Bit 3/HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Underrun Event (H2UDR). Set when the transmit FIFO empties out without
having seen the TMEND bit set. An abort is automatically sent. This bit is latched and is cleared when read.
137 of 238
DS2155
23.3.3 FIFO Information
The transmit FIFO buffer-available register indicates the number of bytes that can be written into the
transmit FIFO. The count form this register informs the host as to how many bytes can be written into the
transmit FIFO without overflowing the buffer.
Register Name:
H1TFBA, H2TFBA
Register Description:
HDLC # 1 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available
HDLC # 2 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available
9Fh, Afh
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TFBA7 TFBA6 TFBA5 TFBA4 TFBA3
TFBA2 TFBA1 TFBA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit FIFO Bytes Available (TFBAO to TFBA7). TFBA0 is the LSB.
23.3.4 Receive Packet-Bytes Available
The lower 7 bits of the receive packet-bytes available register indicates the number of bytes (0 through
127) that can be read from the receive FIFO. The value indicated by this register (lower seven bits)
informs the host as to how many bytes can be read from the receive FIFO without going past the end of a
message. This value refers to one of four possibilities: the first part of a packet, the continuation of a
packet, the last part of a packet, or a complete packet. After reading the number of bytes indicated by this
register, the host then checks the HDLC information register for detailed message status.
If the value in the HxRPBA register refers to the beginning portion of a message or continuation of a
message, then the MSB of the HxRPBA register returns a value of 1. This indicates that the host can
safely read the number of bytes returned by the lower seven bits of the HxRPBA register, but there is no
need to check the information register since the packet has not yet terminated (successfully or otherwise).
Register Name:
H1RPBA, H2RPBA
Register Description:
HDLC # 1 Receive Packet Bytes Available
HDLC # 2 Receive Packet Bytes Available
9Ch, ACh
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
MS
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RPBA6 RPBA5 RPBA4 RPBA3
RPBA2 RPBA1 RPBA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 6/Receive FIFO Packet Bytes Available Count (RPBA0 to RPBA6). RPBA0 is the LSB.
Bit 7/Message Status (MS)
0 = bytes indicated by RPBA0 through RPBA6 are the end of a message. Host must check the INFO5 or
INFO6 register for details.
1 = bytes indicated by RPBA0 through RPBA6 are the beginning or continuation of a message. The host
does not need to check the INFO5 or INFO6 register.
138 of 238
DS2155
23.3.5 HDLC FIFOs
Register Name:
H1TF, H2TF
Register Description:
HDLC # 1 Transmit FIFO
HDLC # 2 Transmit FIFO
9Dh, ADh
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
THD7
0
6
THD6
0
5
THD5
0
4
THD4
0
3
THD3
0
2
THD2
0
1
THD1
0
0
THD0
0
Bit 0/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 0 (THD0). LSB of an HDLC packet data byte.
Bit 1/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 1 (THD1)
Bit 2/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 2 (THD2)
Bit 3/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 3 (THD3)
Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 4 (THD4)
Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 5 (THD5)
Bit 6/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 6 (THD6)
Bit 7/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 7 (THD7). MSB of an HDLC packet data byte.
Register Name:
H1RF, H2RF
Register Description:
HDLC # 1 Receive FIFO
HDLC # 2 Receive FIFO
9Eh, AEh
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RHD7
0
6
RHD6
0
5
RHD5
0
4
RHD4
0
3
RHD3
0
2
RHD2
0
1
RHD1
0
0
RHD0
0
Bit 0/Receive HDLC Data Bit 0 (RHD0). LSB of an HDLC packet data byte.
Bit 1/Receive HDLC Data Bit 1 (RHD1)
Bit 2/Receive HDLC Data Bit 2 (RHD2)
Bit 3/Receive HDLC Data Bit 3 (RHD3)
Bit 4/Receive HDLC Data Bit 4 (RHD4)
Bit 5/Receive HDLC Data Bit 5 (RHD5)
Bit 6/Receive HDLC Data Bit 6 (RHD6)
Bit 7/Receive HDLC Data Bit 7 (RHD7). MSB of an HDLC packet data byte.
139 of 238
DS2155
23.4Receive HDLC Code Example
The following is an example of a receive HDLC routine:
1) Reset receive HDLC controller.
2) Set HDLC mode, mapping, and high watermark.
3) Start new message buffer.
4) Enable RPE and RHWM interrupts.
5) Wait for interrupt.
6) Disable RPE and RHWM interrupts.
7) Read HxRPBA register. N = HxRPBA (lower 7 bits are byte count, MSB is status).
8) Read (N and 7Fh) bytes from receive FIFO and store in message buffer.
9) Read INFO5 register.
10) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 000, then go to Step 4.
11) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 001, then packet terminated OK, save present message buffer.
12) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 010, then packet terminated with CRC error.
13) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 011, then packet aborted.
14) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 100, then FIFO overflowed.
15) Go to Step 3.
23.5Legacy FDL Support (T1 Mode)
23.5.1 Overview
To provide backward compatibility to the older DS21x52 T1 device, the DS2155 maintains the circuitry
that existed in the previous generation of the T1 framer. In new applications, it is recommended that the
HDLC controllers and BOC controller described in Section 21 and 23 are used.
23.5.2 Receive Section
In the receive section, the recovered FDL bits or Fs bits are shifted bit-by-bit into the receive FDL
register (RFDL). Because the RFDL is 8 bits in length, it fills up every 2ms (8 x 250µs). The framer
signals an external microcontroller that the buffer has filled through the SR8.3 bit. If enabled through
IMR8.3, the INT pin toggles low, indicating that the buffer has filled and needs to be read. The user has
2ms to read this data before it is lost. If the byte in the RFDL matches either of the bytes programmed
into the RFDLM1 or RFDLM2 registers, then the SR8.1 bit is set to a 1 and the INT pin toggles low if
enabled through IMR8.1. This feature allows an external microcontroller to ignore the FDL or Fs pattern
until an important event occurs.
The framer also contains a zero destuffer, which is controlled through the T1RCR2.3 bit. In both ANSI
T1.403 and TR54016, communications on the FDL follows a subset of an LAPD protocol. The LAPD
protocol states that no more than five 1s should be transmitted in a row so that the data does not resemble
an opening or closing flag (01111110) or an abort signal (11111111). If enabled through T1RCR2.3, the
DS2155 automatically looks for five 1s in a row, followed by a 0. If it finds such a pattern, it
automatically removes the zero. If the zero destuffer sees six or more 1s in a row followed by a 0, the 0 is
not removed. The T1RCR2.3 bit should always be set to a 1 when the DS2155 is extracting the FDL.
Refer to Application Note 335: DS2141A, DS2151 Controlling the FDL for information about using the
DS2155 in FDL applications in this legacy support mode.
140 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RFDL
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive FDL Register
C0h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RFDL0
0
RFDL7 RFDL6 RFDL5 RFDL4 RFDL3 RFDL2 RFDL1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The receive FDL register (RFDL) reports the incoming FDL or the incoming Fs bits. The LSB is received first.
Bit 0/Receive FDL Bit 0 (RFDL0). LSB of the received FDL code.
Bit 1/Receive FDL Bit 1 (RFDL1)
Bit 2/Receive FDL Bit 2 (RFDL2)
Bit 3/Receive FDL Bit 3 (RFDL3)
Bit 4/Receive FDL Bit 4 (RFDL4)
Bit 5/Receive FDL Bit 5 (RFDL5)
Bit 6/Receive FDL Bit 6 (RFDL6)
Bit 7/Receive FDL Bit 7 (RFDL7). MSB of the received FDL code.
Register Name:
RFDLM1, RFDLM2
Register Description:
Receive FDL Match Register 1
Receive FDL Match Register 2
C2h, C3h
Register Address:
7
RFDLM7
0
6
RFDLM6
0
5
RFDLM5
0
4
RFDLM4
0
3
RFDLM3
0
2
RFDLM2
0
1
0
Bit #
Name
Default
RFDLM1 RFDLM0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive FDL Match Bit 0 (RFDLM0). LSB of the FDL match code.
Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Bit 1 (RFDLM1)
Bit 2/Receive FDL Match Bit 2 (RFDLM2)
Bit 3/Receive FDL Match Bit 3 (RFDLM3)
Bit 4/Receive FDL Match Bit 4 (RFDLM4)
Bit 5/Receive FDL Match Bit 5 (RFDLM5)
Bit 6/Receive FDL Match Bit 6 (RFDLM6)
Bit 7/Receive FDL Match Bit 7 (RFDLM7). MSB of the FDL match code.
141 of 238
DS2155
23.5.3 Transmit Section
The transmit section shifts out into the T1 data stream either the FDL (in the ESF framing mode) or the
Fs bits (in the D4 framing mode) contained in the transmit FDL register (TFDL). When a new value is
written to the TFDL, it is multiplexed serially (LSB first) into the proper position in the outgoing T1 data
stream. After the full 8 bits have been shifted out, the framer signals the host microcontroller by setting
the SR8.2 bit to a 1 that the buffer is empty and that more data is needed. The INT also toggles low if
enabled through IMR8.2. The user has 2ms to update the TFDL with a new value. If the TFDL is not
updated, the old value in the TFDL is transmitted once again. The framer also contains a zero stuffer that
is controlled through the T1TCR2.5 bit. In both ANSI T1.403 and TR54016, communications on the FDL
follows a subset of an LAPD protocol. The LAPD protocol states that no more than five 1s should be
transmitted in a row so that the data does not resemble an opening or closing flag (01111110) or an abort
signal (11111111). If enabled through T1TCR2.5, the framer automatically looks for five 1s in a row. If it
finds such a pattern, it automatically inserts a 0 after the five 1s. The T1TCR2.5 bit should always be set
to a 1 when the framer is inserting the FDL.
Register Name:
TFDL
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit FDL Register
C1h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TFDL0
0
TFDL7 TFDL6 TFDL5 TFDL4 TFDL3
TFDL2 TFDL1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Note: Also used to insert Fs framing pattern in D4 framing mode.
The transmit FDL register (TFDL) contains the FDL information that is to be inserted on a byte basis into the
outgoing T1 data stream. The LSB is transmitted first.
Bit 0/Transmit FDL Bit 0 (TFDL0). LSB of the transmit FDL code.
Bit 1/Transmit FDL Bit 1 (TFDL1)
Bit 2/Transmit FDL Bit 2 (TFDL2)
Bit 3/Transmit FDL Bit 3 (TFDL3)
Bit 4/Transmit FDL Bit 4 (TFDL4)
Bit 5/Transmit FDL Bit 5 (TFDL5)
Bit 6/Transmit FDL Bit 6 (TFDL6)
Bit 7/Transmit FDL Bit 7 (TFDL7). MSB of the transmit FDL code.
23.6D4/SLC-96 Operation
In the D4 framing mode, the framer uses the TFDL register to insert the Fs framing pattern. To allow the
device to properly insert the Fs framing pattern, the TFDL register at address C1h must be programmed to
1Ch and the following bits must be programmed as shown:
T1TCR1.2 = 0 (source Fs data from the TFDL register)
T1TCR2.6 = 1 (allow the TFDL register to load on multiframe boundaries)
Since the SLC-96 message fields share the Fs-bit position, the user can access these message fields
through the TFDL and RFDL registers. Refer to Application Note 345: DS2141A, DS2151, DS2152 SLC-
96 for a detailed description about implementing an SLC-96 function.
142 of 238
DS2155
24. LINE INTERFACE UNIT (LIU)
The LIU contains three sections: the receiver that handles clock and data recovery, the transmitter that
waveshapes and drives the T1 line, and the jitter attenuator. These three sections are controlled by the line
interface control registers (LIC1–LIC4), which are described in the following sections. The LIU has its
own T1/E1 mode-select bit and can operate independently of the framer function.
The DS2155 can switch between T1 or E1 networks without changing any external components on either
the transmit or receive side. Figure 24-3 shows a network connection using minimal components. In this
configuration, the DS2155 can connect to T1, J1, or E1 (75Ω or 120Ω) without any component change.
The receiver can adjust the 120Ω termination to 100Ω or 75Ω. The transmitter can adjust its output
impedance to provide high return-loss characteristics for 120Ω, 100Ω, and 75Ω lines. Other components
can be added to this configuration to meet safety and network protection requirements (Section 24.8).
24.1LIU Operation
The analog AMI/HDB3 waveform off the E1 line or the AMI/B8ZS waveform off of the T1 line is
transformer-coupled into the RTIP and RRING pins of the DS2155. The user has the option to use
internal termination, software selectable for 75Ω/100Ω/120Ω applications, or external termination. The
LIU recovers clock and data from the analog signal and passes it through the jitter-attenuation mux
outputting the received line clock at RCLKO and bipolar or NRZ data at RPOSO and RNEGO. The
DS2155 contains an active filter that reconstructs the analog-received signal for the nonlinear losses that
occur in transmission. The receive circuitry also is configurable for various monitor applications. The
device has a usable receive sensitivity of 0dB to -43dB for E1 and 0dB to -36dB for T1, which allow the
device to operate on 0.63mm (22AWG) cables up to 2.5km (E1) and 6k feet (T1) in length. Data input at
TPOSI and TNEGI is sent through the jitter-attenuation mux to the waveshaping circuitry and line driver.
The DS2155 drives the E1 or T1 line from the TTIP and TRING pins through a coupling transformer.
The line driver can handle both CEPT 30/ISDN-PRI lines for E1 and long-haul (CSU) or short-haul
(DSX-1) lines for T1.
24.2Receiver
The DS2155 contains a digital clock recovery system. The DS2155 couples to the receive E1 or T1
twisted pair (or coaxial cable in 75Ω E1 applications) through a 1:1 transformer. See Table 24-C for
transformer details. The DS2155 has the option of using software-selectable termination requiring only a
single fixed pair of termination resistors.
The DS2155’s LIU is designed to be fully software selectable for E1 and T1, requiring no change to any
external resistors for the receive side. The receive side allows the user to configure the DS2155 for 75Ω,
100Ω, or 120Ω receive termination by setting the RT1 (LIC4.1) and RT0 (LIC4.0) bits. When using the
internal termination feature, the resistors labeled R in Figure 24-3 should be 60Ω each. If external
termination is used, RT1 and RT0 should be set to 0 and the resistors labeled R in Figure 24-3 should be
37.5Ω, 50Ω, or 60Ω each, depending on the line impedance.
There are two ranges of user-selectable receive sensitivity for T1 and E1. The EGL bit of LIC1 (LIC1.4)
selects the full or limited sensitivity. The resultant E1 or T1 clock derived from MCLK is multiplied by
16 through an internal PLL and fed to the clock recovery system. The clock recovery system uses the
clock from the PLL circuit to form a 16-times over-sampler that is used to recover the clock and data.
This over-sampling technique offers outstanding performance to meet jitter tolerance specifications
shown in Figure 24-7.
143 of 238
DS2155
Normally, the clock that is output at the RCLK pin is the recovered clock from the E1 AMI/HDB3 or T1
AMI/B8ZS waveform presented at the RTIP and RRING inputs. If the jitter attenuator is placed in the
receive path (as is the case in most applications), the jitter attenuator restores the RCLK to an
approximate 50% duty cycle. If the jitter attenuator is either placed in the transmit path or is disabled, the
RCLK output can exhibit slightly shorter high cycles of the clock. This is because of the highly over-
sampled digital-clock recovery circuitry. See the Receive AC Timing Characteristics in Section 37.3 for
more details. When no signal is present at RTIP and RRING, a receive carrier loss (RCL) condition
occurs and the RCLK is derived from the JACLK source.
24.2.1 Receive Level Indicator and Threshold Interrupt
The DS2155 reports the signal strength at RTIP and RRING in 2.5dB increments through RL3–RL0
located in Information Register 2 (INFO2). This feature is helpful when trouble-shooting line-
performance problems. The DS2155 can initiate an interrupt whenever the input falls below a certain
level through the input-level under-threshold indicator (SR1.7). Using the RLT0–RLT4 bits of the CCR4
register, the user can set a threshold in 2.5dB increments. The SR1.7 bit is set whenever the input level at
RTIP and RRING falls below the threshold set by the value in RLT0–RLT4. The level must remain
below the programmed threshold for approximately 50ms for this bit to be set. The accuracy of the
receive level indication is +/- 1 LSB (2.5dB) from 25C to 85C and +/- 2 LSB’s (5dB) from –40C to 25C.
24.2.2 Receive G.703 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode)
The DS2155 is capable of receiving a 2.048MHz square-wave synchronization clock as specified in
Section 13 of ITU G.703, October 1998. In order to use the DS2155 in this mode, set the receive
synchronization clock enable (LIC3.2) = 1.
24.2.3 Monitor Mode
Monitor applications in both E1 and T1 require various flat gain settings for the receive-side circuitry.
The DS2155 can be programmed to support these applications through the monitor mode control bits
MM1 and MM0 in the LIC3 register (Figure 24-1).
Figure 24-1. Typical Monitor Application
PRIMARY
T1/E1 LINE
Rm
T1/E1 TERMINATING
DEVICE
Rm
X
F
DS2156
Rt
M
R
MONITOR
PORT JACK
SECONDARY T1/E1
TERMINATING
DEVICE
144 of 238
DS2155
24.3Transmitter
The DS2155 uses a phase-lock loop along with a precision digital-to-analog converter (DAC) to create
the waveforms that are transmitted onto the E1 or T1 line. The waveforms created by the DS2155 meet
the latest ETSI, ITU, ANSI, and AT&T specifications. The user selects which waveform is generated by
setting the ETS bit (LIC2.7) for E1 or T1 operation, then programming the L2/L1/L0 bits in register LIC1
for the appropriate application.
A 2.048MHz or 1.544MHz clock is required at TCLKI for transmitting data presented at TPOSI and
TNEGI. Normally these pins are connected to TCLKO, TPOSO, and TNEGO. However, the LIU can
operate in an independent fashion. ITU specification G.703 requires an accuracy of ±50ppm for both T1
and E1. TR62411 and ANSI specifications require an accuracy of ±32ppm for T1 interfaces. The clock
can be sourced internally from RCLK or JACLK. See LIC2.3, LIC4.4, and LIC4.5 for details. Because of
the nature of the transmitter’s design, very little jitter (less than 0.005UIP-P broadband from 10Hz to
100kHz) is added to the jitter present on TCLK. Also, the waveforms created are independent of the duty
cycle of TCLK. The transmitter in the DS2155 couples to the E1 or T1 transmit twisted pair (or coaxial
cable in some E1 applications) through a 1:2 step-up transformer. For the device to create the proper
waveforms, the transformer used must meet the specifications listed in Table 24-C. The DS2155 has the
option of using software-selectable transmit termination.
The transmit line drive has two modes of operation: fixed gain or automatic gain. In the fixed gain mode,
the transmitter outputs a fixed current into the network load to achieve a nominal pulse amplitude. In the
automatic gain mode, the transmitter adjusts its output level to compensate for slight variances in the
network load. See the Transmit Line Build-Out Control (TLBC) register for details.
24.3.1 Transmit Short-Circuit Detector/Limiter
The DS2155 has an automatic short-circuit limiter that limits the source current to 50mA (RMS) into a
1Ω load. This feature can be disabled by setting the SCLD bit (LIC2.1) = 1. TCLE (INFO2.5) provides a
real-time indication of when the current limiter is activated. If the current limiter is disabled, TCLE
indicates that a short-circuit condition exists. Status Register SR1.2 provides a latched version of the
information, which can be used to activate an interrupt when enabled by the IMR1 register. The TPD bit
(LIC1.0) powers down the transmit line driver and tri-states the TTIP and TRING pins.
24.3.2 Transmit Open-Circuit Detector
The DS2155 can also detect when the TTIP or TRING outputs are open circuited. TOCD (INFO2.4)
provides a real-time indication of when an open circuit is detected. SR1 provides a latched version of the
information (SR1.1), which can be used to activate an interrupt when enabled by the IMR1 register.
24.3.3 Transmit BPV Error Insertion
When IBPV (LIC2.5) is transitioned from a 0 to a 1, the device waits for the next occurrence of three
consecutive 1s to insert a BPV. IBPV must be cleared and set again for another BPV error insertion.
24.3.4 Transmit G.703 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode)
The DS2155 can transmit the 2.048MHz square-wave synchronization clock as specified in Section 13 of
ITU G.703, October 1998. In order to transmit the 2.048MHz clock, when in E1 mode, set the transmit
synchronization clock enable (LIC3.1) = 1.
145 of 238
DS2155
24.4MCLK Prescaler
A 16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, 2.048MHz, or 1.544MHz clock must be applied at MCLK. ITU
specification G.703 requires an accuracy of ±50ppm for both T1 and E1. TR62411 and ANSI
specifications require an accuracy of ±32ppm for T1 interfaces. A prescaler divides the 16MHz, 8MHz,
or 4MHz clock down to 2.048MHz. There is an on-board PLL for the jitter attenuator, which converts the
2.048MHz clock to a 1.544MHz rate for T1 applications. Setting JAMUX (LIC2.3) to a logic 0 bypasses
this PLL.
24.5Jitter Attenuator
The DS2155 contains an on-board jitter attenuator that can be set to a depth of either 32 or 128 bits
through the JABDS bit (LIC1.2). The 128-bit mode is used in applications where large excursions of
wander are expected. The 32-bit mode is used in delay-sensitive applications. The characteristics of the
attenuation are shown in Figure 24-9. The jitter attenuator can be placed in either the receive path or the
transmit path by appropriately setting or clearing the JAS bit (LIC1.3). Setting the DJA bit (LIC1.1)
disables (in effect, removes) the jitter attenuator. On-board circuitry adjusts either the recovered clock
from the clock/data recovery block or the clock applied at the TCLK pin to create a smooth jitter-free
clock that is used to clock data out of the jitter attenuator FIFO. It is acceptable to provide a
gapped/bursty clock at the TCLK pin if the jitter attenuator is placed on the transmit side. If the incoming
jitter exceeds either 120UIP-P (buffer depth is 128 bits) or 28UIP-P (buffer depth is 32 bits), then the
DS2155 divides the internal nominal 32.768MHz (E1) or 24.704MHz (T1) clock by either 15 or 17
instead of the normal 16 to keep the buffer from overflowing. When the device divides by either 15 or 17,
it also sets the jitter attenuator limit trip (JALT) bit in Status Register 1 (SR1.4).
24.6CMI (Code Mark Inversion) Option
The DS2155 provides a CMI interface for connection to optical transports. This interface is a unipolar
1T2B signal type. Ones are encoded as either a logical 1 or 0 level for the full duration of the clock
period. Zeros are encoded as a 0-to-1 transition at the middle of the clock period.
Figure 24-2. CMI Coding
CLOCK
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
DATA
CMI
Transmit and receive CMI are enabled through LIC4.7. When this register bit is set, the TTIP pin outputs
CMI-coded data at normal levels. This signal can be used to directly drive an optical interface. When
CMI is enabled, the user can also use HDB3/B8ZS coding. When this register bit is set, the RTIP pin
becomes a unipolar CMI input. The CMI signal is processed to extract and align the clock with data.
146 of 238
DS2155
24.7 LIU Control Registers
Register Name:
LIC1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Line Interface Control 1
78h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
L2
0
6
L1
0
5
L0
0
4
EGL
0
3
JAS
0
2
JABDS
0
1
DJA
0
0
TPD
0
Bit 0/Transmit Power-Down (TPD)
0 = powers down the transmitter and tri-states the TTIP and TRING pins
1 = normal transmitter operation
Bit 1/Disable Jitter Attenuator (DJA)
0 = jitter attenuator enabled
1 = jitter attenuator disabled
Bit 2/Jitter Attenuator Buffer Depth Select (JABDS)
0 = 128 bits
1 = 32 bits (use for delay-sensitive applications)
Bit 3/Jitter Attenuator Select (JAS)
0 = place the jitter attenuator on the receive side
1 = place the jitter attenuator on the transmit side
Bit 4/Receive Equalizer Gain Limit (EGL). This bit controls the sensitivity of the receive equalizer.
T1 Mode
0 = -36dB (long haul)
1 = -15dB (limited long haul)
E1 Mode
0 = -12dB (short haul)
1 = -43dB (long haul)
Bits 5 to 7/Line Buildout Select (L0 to L2). When using the internal termination, the user needs only to select 000
for 75Ω operation or 001 for 120Ω operation below. This selects the proper voltage levels for 75Ω or 120Ω
operation. Using TT0 and TT1 of the LICR4 register, the user can then select the proper internal source
termination. Line buildouts 100 and 101 are for backwards compatibility with older products only.
E1 Mode
L2 L1
L0
0
Application
N (1)
1:2
Return Loss Rt (1) (Ω)
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
75Ω normal
NM
NM
0
0
1
120Ω normal
1:2
0
1
75Ω with high return loss*
1:2
1:2
21dB
21dB
6.2
11.6
120Ω with high return loss*
*TT0 and TT1 of LIC4 register must be set to 0 in this configuration.
147 of 238
DS2155
T1 Mode
L2
L1
0
L0
0
Application
DSX-1 (0ft to 133ft) / 0dB CSU
DSX-1 (133ft to 266ft)
DSX-1 (266ft to 399ft)
DSX-1 (399ft to 533ft)
DSX-1 (533ft to 655ft)
-7.5dB CSU
N (1) Return Loss Rt (1) (Ω)
0
1:2
1:2
1:2
1:2
1:2
1:2
1:2
1:2
NM
NM
NM
NM
NM
NM
NM
NM
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
-15dB CSU
1
1
1
-22.5dB CSU
148 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TLBC
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Line Build-Out Control
7Dh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-
0
6
AGCE
0
5
GC5
0
4
GC4
0
3
GC3
0
2
GC2
0
1
GC1
0
0
GC0
0
Bit 0–5 Gain Control Bits 0–5 (GC0–GC5). The GC0 through GC5 bits control the gain setting for the
nonautomatic gain mode. Use the tables below for setting the recommended values. The LB (line build-out)
column refers to the value in the
L0–L2 bits in LIC1 (Line Interface Control 1) register.
NETWORK MODE
LB GC5 GC4 GC3 GC2 GC1 GC0
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
4
5
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
T1, Impedance Match
Off
T1, Impedance Match On
E1, Impedance Match
Off
E1, Impedance Match On
Bit 6/Automatic Gain Control Enable (AGCE).
0 = use Transmit AGC, TLBC bits 0–5 are “don’t care”
1 = do not use Transmit AGC, TLBC bits 0–5 set nominal level
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation.
149 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
LIC2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Line Interface Control 2
79h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
ETS
0
6
LIRST
0
5
IBPV
0
4
3
2
—
0
1
SCLD
0
0
CLDS
0
TUA1 JAMUX
0
0
Bit 0/Custom Line Driver Select (CLDS). Setting this bit to a 1 redefines the operation of the transmit line
driver. When this bit is set to a 1 and LIC1.5 = LIC1.6 = LIC1.7 = 0, the device generates a square wave at the
TTIP and TRING outputs instead of a normal waveform. When this bit is set to a 1 and LIC1.5 = LIC1.6 = LIC1.7
≠ 0, the device forces TTIP and TRING outputs to become open-drain drivers instead of their normal push-pull
operation. This bit should be set to 0 for normal operation of the device.
Bit 1/Short-Circuit Limit Disable (ETS = 1) (SCLD). Controls the 50mA (RMS) current limiter.
0 = enable 50mA current limiter
1 = disable 50mA current limiter
Bit 2/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Bit 3/Jitter Attenuator Mux (JAMUX). Controls the source for JACLK.
0 = JACLK sourced from MCLK (2.048MHz or 1.544MHz at MCLK)
1 = JACLK sourced from internal PLL (2.048MHz at MCLK)
Bit 4/Transmit Unframed All Ones (TUA1). The polarity of this bit is set such that the device transmits an all-
ones pattern on power-up or device reset. This bit must be set to a 1 to allow the device to transmit data. The
transmission of this data pattern is always timed off of the JACLK.
0 = transmit all ones at TTIP and TRING
1 = transmit data normally
Bit 5/Insert BPV (IBPV). A 0-to-1 transition on this bit causes a single BPV to be inserted into the transmit data
stream. Once this bit has been toggled from a 0 to a 1, the device waits for the next occurrence of three consecutive
1s to insert the BPV. This bit must be cleared and set again for a subsequent error to be inserted.
Bit 6/Line Interface Reset (LIRST). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 initiates an internal reset that resets the clock
recovery state machine and recenters the jitter attenuator. Normally this bit is only toggled on power-up. Must be
cleared and set again for a subsequent reset.
Bit 7/E1/T1 Select (ETS)
0 = T1 mode selected
1 = E1 mode selected
150 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
LIC3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Line Interface Control 3
7Ah
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
TCES
0
5
RCES
0
4
MM1
0
3
2
1
0
MM0 RSCLKE TSCLKE TAOZ
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit Alternate Ones and Zeros (TAOZ). Transmit a …101010… pattern (customer disconnect
indication signal) at TTIP and TRING. The transmission of this data pattern is always timed off of TCLK.
0 = disabled
1 = enabled
Bit 1/Transmit Synchronization G.703 Clock Enable (TSCLKE)
0 = disable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) transmit synchronization clock
1 = enable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) transmit synchronization clock
Bit 2/Receive Synchronization G.703 Clock Enable (RSCLKE)
0 = disable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) synchronization receive mode
1 = enable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) synchronization receive mode
Bits 3 to 4/Monitor Mode (MM0 to MM1)
Internal Linear Gain Boost
MM1
MM0
(dB)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal operation (no boost)
20
26
32
Bit 5/Receive-Clock Edge Select (RCES). Selects which RCLKO edge to update RPOSO and RNEGO.
0 = update RPOSO and RNEGO on rising edge of RCLKO
1 = update RPOSO and RNEGO on falling edge of RCLKO
Bit 6/Transmit-Clock Edge Select (TCES). Selects which TCLKI edge to sample TPOSI and TNEGI.
0 = sample TPOSI and TNEGI on falling edge of TCLKI
1 = sample TPOSI and TNEGI on rising edge of TCLKI
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
151 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
LIC4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Line Interface Control 4
7Bh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CMIE
0
6
CMII
0
5
MPS1
0
4
MPS0
0
3
TT1
0
2
TT0
0
1
RT1
0
0
RT0
0
Bits 0, 1/Receive Termination Select (RT0, RT1)
RT1
RT0
Internal Receive-Termination Configuration
Internal receive-side termination disabled
Internal receive-side 75Ω enabled
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Internal receive-side 100Ω enabled
Internal receive-side 120Ω enabled
Bits 2, 3/Transmit Termination Select (TT0, TT1)
TT1
TT0
Internal Transmit-Termination Configuration
Internal transmit-side termination disabled
Internal transmit -side 75Ω enabled
Internal transmit -side 100Ω enabled
Internal transmit -side 120Ω enabled
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Bits 4, 5/MCLK Prescaler for T1 Mode
MCLK
JAMUX
MPS1
MPS0
(MHz)
1.544
3.088
6.176
12.352
2.048
4.096
8.192
16.384
(LIC2.3)
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Bits 4, 5/MCLK Prescaler for E1 Mode
MCLK
JAMUX
MPS1
MPS0
(MHz)
2.048
4.096
8.192
16.384
(LIC2.3)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
Bit 6/CMI Invert (CMII)
0 = CMI normal at TTIP and RTIP
1 = invert CMI signal at TTIP and RTIP
Bit 7/CMI Enable (CMIE)
0 = disable CMI mode
1 = enable CMI mode
152 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
INFO2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Information Register 2
11h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
BSYNC
0
6
BD
0
5
TCLE
0
4
TOCD
0
3
RL3
0
2
RL2
0
1
RL1
0
0
RL0
0
Bits 0 to 3/Receive Level Bits (RL0 to RL3). Real-time bits
RL3
0
RL2
0
RL1
0
RL0
0
Receive Level (dB)
Greater than -2.5
-2.5 to -5.0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
-5.0 to -7.5
0
0
1
1
-7.5 to -10.0
0
1
0
0
-10.0 to -12.5
-12.5 to -15.0
-15.0 to -17.5
-17.5 to -20.0
-20.0 to -22.5
-22.5 to -25.0
-25.0 to -27.5
-27.5 to -30.0
-30.0 to -32.5
-32.5 to -35.0
-35.0 to -37.5
Less than -37.5
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
NOTE: RL0 through RL3 only indicate the signal range as specified by the EGL bit in LIC1. Example; if
EGL = 1 and in T1 mode, RL0 through RL3 will only indicate a signal range of >-2.5dB to –15dB even if the
signal is < -15dB.
Bit 4/Transmit Open-Circuit Detect (TOCD). A real-time bit that is set when the device detects that the TTIP
and TRING outputs are open-circuited.
Bit 5/Transmit Current-Limit Exceeded (TCLE). A real-time bit that is set when the 50mA (RMS) current
limiter is activated, whether the current limiter is enabled or not.
Bit 6/BOC Detected (BD). A real-time bit that is set high when the BOC detector is presently seeing a valid
sequence and set low when no BOC is currently being detected.
Bit 7/BERT Real-Time Synchronization Status (BSYNC). Real-time status of the synchronizer (this bit is not
latched). This bit is set when the incoming pattern matches for 32 consecutive bit positions. It is cleared when six
or more bits out of 64 are received in error. Refer to BSYNC in the BERT status register, SR9, for an interrupt-
generating version of this signal.
153 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Status Register 1
16h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
ILUT
0
6
5
4
JALT
0
3
LRCL
0
2
TCLE
0
1
TOCD
0
0
LOLITC
0
TIMER RSCOS
0
0
Bit 0/Loss of Line-Interface Transmit-Clock Condition (LOLITC). Set when TCLKI has not transitioned for
one channel time. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).
Bit 1/Transmit Open-Circuit Detect Condition (TOCD). Set when the device detects that the TTIP and TRING
outputs are open-circuited. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).
Bit 2/Transmit Current-Limit Exceeded Condition (TCLE). Set when the 50mA (RMS) current limiter is
activated, whether the current limiter is enabled or not. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).
Bit 3/Line Interface Receive Carrier-Loss Condition (LRCL). Set when the carrier signal is lost. This is a
double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).
Bit 4/Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Event (JALT). Set when the jitter attenuator FIFO reaches to within 4 bits of
its useful limit. This bit is cleared when read. Useful for debugging jitter attenuation operation.
Bit 5/Receive Signaling Change-of-State Event (RSCOS). Set when any channel selected by the receive
signaling change-of-state interrupt-enable registers (RSCSE1 through RSCSE4) changes signaling state.
Bit 6/Timer Event (TIMER). Follows the error-counter update interval as determined by the ECUS bit in the
error-counter configuration register (ERCNT).
T1: set on increments of 1 second or 42ms based on RCLK
E1: set on increments of 1 second or 62.5ms based on RCLK
Bit 7/Input Level Under Threshold (ILUT). This bit is set whenever the input level at RTIP and RRING falls
below the threshold set by the value in CCR4.4 through CCR4.7. The level must remain below the programmed
threshold for approximately 50ms for this bit to be set. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).
154 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IMR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Mask Register 1
17h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
ILUT
0
6
5
4
JALT
0
3
LRCL
0
2
TCLE
0
1
TOCD
0
0
LOLITC
0
TIMER RSCOS
0
0
Bit 0/Loss-of-Transmit Clock Condition (LOLITC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—generates interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 1/Transmit Open-Circuit Detect Condition (TOCD)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—generates interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 2/Transmit Current-Limit Exceeded Condition (TCLE)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—generates interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 3/Line Interface Receive Carrier-Loss Condition (LRCL)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—generates interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 4/Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Event (JALT)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 5/Receive Signaling Change-of-State Event (RSCOS)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 6/Timer Event (TIMER)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 7/Input Level Under Threshold (ILUT)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
155 of 238
DS2155
24.8 Recommended Circuits
Figure 24-3. Software-Selected Termination, Metallic Protection
VCC
TTIP
DVDD
DVSS
1.0 µF
T1
0.01 µF2
0.1 µF 2
T3 1
F1
75/100/110/120 Ω
Tw isted Pair/Coax
S3
S1
TRING
VCC
VCC
2:1
68 µF2
Dallas Semiconductor
T1/E1/J1 SCT or LIU
RTIP
TVDD
TVSS
RVDD
RVSS
T2
0.1 µF 2
0.1 µF 2
T4 1
F2
75/100/110/120 Ω
Tw isted Pair/Coax
S4
S2
RRING
1:1
60 Ω
60 Ω
Design Notes:
1 Choke is optional but should be included when necessary for common mode noise reduction.
0.1 µF
2
Decoupling capacitors need to be placed near dev ice power pins
Table 24-A. Component List (Software-Selected Termination, Metallic
Protection)
NAME
DESCRIPTION
F1 and F2
S1 and S2
S3 andS4
T1 and T2
T3 and T4
1.25A slow blow fuse
25V (max) transient suppressor
77V (max) transient suppressor
Transformer 1:1CT and 1:2CT (3.3V, SMT)
Dual common-mode choke (SMT)
T3 and T4 are optional. For more information, contact the Telecom Support Group at
telecom.support@dalsemi.com.
The layout from the transformers to the network interface is critical. Traces should be at least 25
mils wide and separated from other circuit lines by at least 150 mils. The area under this portion
of the circuit should not contain power planes.
Some T1 (never in E1) applications source or sink power from the network-side center taps of
the Rx/Tx transformers.
A list of transformer part numbers and manufacturers is available by contacting
telecom.support@dalsemi.com.
Note 1:
Note 2:
Note 3:
Note 4:
156 of 238
DS2155
0.1 µF 2
Figure 24-4. Software-Selected Termination, Longitudinal Protection
VCC
TTIP
DVDD
1.0 µF
F1
T1
0.01 µF2
T3 1
DVSS
S3
S4
100/110/120 Ω
Tw isted Pair
S7
S1
TRING
F2
VCC
VCC
2:1
68 µF2
Dallas Semiconductor
T1/E1/J1 SCT or LIU
RTIP
TVDD
TVSS
RVDD
RVSS
F3
F4
T2
0.1 µF 2
0.1 µF 2
T4 1
S5
S6
100/110/120 Ω
Tw isted Pair
S8
S2
RRING
1:1
60 Ω
60 Ω
Design Notes:
1 Choke is optional but should be included when necessary f or common mode noise reduction.
0.1 µF
2
Decoupling capacitors need to be placed near device power pins
Table 24-B. Component List (Software-Selected Termination, Longitudinal
Protection)
NAME
F1 to F4
S1 and S2
DESCRIPTION
1.25A slow blow fuse
25V (max) transient suppressor
S3, S4, S5, S6 180V (max) transient suppressor
S7 and S8
T1 and T2
T3 and T4
40V (max) transient suppressor
Transformer 1:1CT and 1:2CT (3.3V, SMT)
Dual common-mode choke (SMT)
T3 and T4 are optional. For more information, contact the Telecom Support Group at
telecom.support@dalsemi.com.
Note 1:
Note 2:
Note 3:
A list of alternate transformer part numbers and manufacturers is available at
telecom.support@dalsemi.com.
The layout from the transformers to the network interface is critical. Traces should be at least 25
mils wide and separated from other circuit lines by at least 150 mils. The area under this portion
of the circuit should not contain power planes.
Some T1 (never in E1) applications source or sink power from the network-side center taps of
the Rx/Tx transformers.
The ground trace connected to the S2/S3 pair and the S4/S5 pair should be at least 50 mils wide
to conduct the extra current from a longitudinal power-cross event.
Note 4:
Note 5:
157 of 238
DS2155
24.9Component Specifications
Table 24-C. Transformer Specifications
SPECIFICATION
RECOMMENDED VALUE
Turns Ratio 3.3V Applications
Primary Inductance
1:1 (receive) and 1:2 (transmit) ±2%
600µH (min)
Leakage Inductance
1.0µH (max)
Intertwining Capacitance
Transmit Transformer DC Resistance
Primary (Device Side)
Secondary
Receive Transformer DC Resistance
Primary (Device Side)
Secondary
40pF (max)
1.0Ω (max)
2.0Ω (max)
1.2Ω (max)
1.2Ω (max)
158 of 238
DS2155
Figure 24-5. E1 Transmit Pulse Template
1.2
1.1
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
269ns
G.703
TEMPLATE
194ns
0.6
0.5
219ns
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
-0.1
-0.2
-250
-200
-150
-100
-50
0
50
100
150
200
250
TIME (ns)
Figure 24-6. T1 Transmit Pulse Template
1.2
1.1
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
MAXIMUM CURVE
UI Time Amp.
MINIMUM CURVE
UI Time Amp.
-0.77 -500 0.05
-0.39 -255 0.05
-0.27 -175 0.80
-0.27 -175 1.15
-0.77 -500 -0.05
-0.23 -150 -0.05
-0.23 -150 0.50
-0.15 -100 0.95
-0.12 -75
1.15
1.05
1.05
-0.07
0.05
0.05
0.00
0
0.95
0.00
0
0.15 100
0.23 150
0.23 150
0.46 300
0.66 430
0.93 600
1.16 750
0.90
0.27 175
0.35 225
0.93 600
1.16 750
0.50
-0.45
-0.45
-0.20
-0.05
-0.05
-0.1
T1.102/87, T1.403,
-0.2
-0.3
-0.4
-0.5
CB 119 (OCT. 79), AND
I.431 TEMPLATE
-500 -400 -300 -200 -100
0
100
200
300
400
500
600
700
TIME (ns)
159 of 238
DS2155
Figure 24-7. Jitter Tolerance
1k
DS2155
TOLERANCE
100
TR 62411 (DEC. 90)
10
1
ITU-T G.823
0.1
1
10
100
1k
10k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 24-8. Jitter Tolerance (E1 Mode)
1k
DS2155
TOLERANCE
100
40
10
1.5
1
MINIMUM TOLERANCE
LEVEL AS PER
ITU G.823
0.2
0.1
2.4k
20
18k
1
10
100
1k
10k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
160 of 238
DS2155
Figure 24-9. Jitter Attenuation (T1 Mode)
0dB
-20dB
-40dB
TR 62411 (Dec. 90)
Prohibited Area
DS2155
T1 MODE
-60dB
1
10
100
1K
10K
100K
FREQUENCY (Hz)
Figure 24-10. Jitter Attenuation (E1 Mode)
0
ITU G.7XX
TBR12
Prohibited
Area
Prohibited Area
-20
DS2155
E1 MODE
-40
-60
1
10
100
1k
10k
100k
FREQUENCY (Hz)
161 of 238
DS2155
Figure 24-11. Optional Crystal Connections
DS2155
XTALD
1.544MHz/2.048MHz
MCLK
C1
C2
Note 1: C1 and C2 should be 5pF lower than two times the nominal loading capacitance of the crystal to adjust for the input capacitance of the
DS2155.
162 of 238
DS2155
25. PROGRAMMABLE IN-BAND LOOP CODE GENERATION AND
DETECTION
The DS2155 has the ability to generate and detect a repeating bit pattern from one to eight bits or 16 bits
in length. This function is available only in T1 mode. To transmit a pattern, the user loads the pattern
into the transmit code-definition registers (TCD1 and TCD2) and selects the proper length of the pattern
by setting the TC0 and TC1 bits in the in-band code control (IBCC) register. When generating a 1-, 2-, 4-,
8-, or 16-bit pattern, both transmit code-definition registers must be filled with the proper code.
Generation of a 3-, 5-, 6-, and 7-bit pattern only requires TCD1 to be filled. Once this is accomplished,
the pattern is transmitted as long as the TLOOP control bit (T1CCR1.0) is enabled. Normally (unless the
transmit formatter is programmed to not insert the F-bit position) the framer overwrites the repeating
pattern once every 193 bits to send the F-bit position.
For example, to transmit the standard “loop-up” code for CSUs, which is a repeating pattern of
...10000100001... , set TCD1 = 80h, IBCC = 0, and T1CCR1.0 = 1.
The framer has three programmable pattern detectors. Typically two of the detectors are used for “loop-
up” and “loop-down” code detection. The user programs the codes to be detected in the receive up-code
definition (RUPCD1 and RUPCD2) registers and the receive down-code definition (RDNCD1 and
RDNCD2) registers, and the length of each pattern is selected through the IBCC register. There is a third
detector (spare) that is defined and controlled through the RSCD1/RSCD2 and RSCC registers. When
detecting a 16-bit pattern, both receive code-definition registers are used together to form a 16-bit
register. For 8-bit patterns, both receive code-definition registers are filled with the same value. Detection
of a 1-, 2-, 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, and 7-bit pattern only requires the first receive code-definition register to be
filled. The framer detects repeating pattern codes in both framed and unframed circumstances with bit
error rates as high as 10E-2. The detectors are capable of handling both F-bit inserted and F-bit overwrite
patterns. Writing the least significant byte of the receive code-definition register resets the integration
period for that detector. The code detector has a nominal integration period of 36ms. Hence, after about
36ms of receiving a valid code, the proper status bit (LUP at SR3.5, LDN at SR3.6, and LSPARE at
SR3.7) is set to a 1. Normally codes are sent for a period of five seconds. It is recommended that the
software poll the framer every 50ms to 1000ms until five seconds has elapsed to ensure the code is
continuously present.
163 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IBCC
Register Description:
Register Address:
In-Band Code Control Register
B6h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TC1
0
6
TC0
0
5
RUP2
0
4
RUP1
0
3
RUP0
0
2
RDN2
0
1
RDN1
0
0
RDN0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Receive Down-Code Length Definition Bits (RDN0 to RDN2)
RDN2
RDN1
RDN0
Length Selected (bits)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8/16
Bits 3 to 5/Receive Up-Code Length Definition Bits (RUP0 to RUP2)
RUP2
RUP1
RUP0
Length Selected (bits)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8/16
Bits 6, 7/Transmit Code Length Definition Bits (TC0 to TC1)
TC1
TC0
Length Selected (bits)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
5
6/3
7
16/8/4/2/1
164 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
TCD1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Code-Definition Register 1
B7h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bit 0/Transmit Code-Definition Bit 0 (C0). A don’t care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 1/Transmit Code-Definition Bit 1 (C1). A don’t care if a 5-bit or 6-bit length is selected.
Bit 2/Transmit Code-Definition Bit 2 (C2). A don’t care if a 5-bit length is selected.
Bits 3–6/Transmit Code-Definition Bits 3–6 (C3–C6)
Bit 7/Transmit Code-Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.
Register Name:
TCD2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Transmit Code Definition Register 2
B8h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Least significant byte of 16 bit codes.
Bits 0–7/Transmit Code-Definition Bits 0–7 (C0–C7). A don’t care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
165 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RUPCD1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Up-Code Definition Register 1
B9h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.
Bit 0/Receive Up-Code Definition Bits 0 (C0). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 1/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected.
Bit 2/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected.
Bit 3/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 4-bit length is selected.
Bit 4/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected.
Bit 5/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A don’t care if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected.
Bit 6/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A don’t care if a 1-bit length is selected.
Bit 7/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.
Register Name:
RUPCD2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Up-Code Definition Register 2
BAh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bits 0–7/Receive Up-Code Definition Bits 0–7 (C0–C7). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.
166 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RDNCD1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Down-Code Definition Register 1
BBh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.
Bit 0/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 1/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected.
Bit 2/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected.
Bit 3/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 4-bit length is selected.
Bit 4/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected.
Bit 5/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A don’t care if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected.
Bit 6/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A don’t care if a 1-bit length is selected.
Bit 7/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.
Register Name:
RDNCD2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Down-Code Definition Register 2
BCh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bits 0–7/Receive Down-Code Definition Bits 0–7 (C0–C7). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.
167 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RSCC
Register Description:
Register Address:
In-Band Receive Spare Control Register
BDh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
RSC2
0
1
RSC1
0
0
RSC0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Receive Spare Code Length Definition Bits (RSC0 to RSC2)
RSC2
RSC1
RSC0
Length Selected (bits)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8/16
Bits 3 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
168 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
RSCD1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Spare-Code Definition Register 1
BEh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.
Bit 0/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 1/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected.
Bit 2/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected.
Bit 3/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 4-bit length is selected.
Bit 4/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected.
Bit 5/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A don’t care if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected.
Bit 6/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A don’t care if a 1-bit length is selected.
Bit 7/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.
Register Name:
RSCD2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 2
BFh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bits 0–7/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bits 0–7 (C0–C7). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.
169 of 238
DS2155
26. BERT FUNCTION
The BERT block can generate and detect pseudorandom and repeating bit patterns. It is used to test and
stress data communication links, and it is capable of generating and detecting the following patterns:
ꢀ The pseudorandom patterns 2E7, 2E11, 2E15, and QRSS
ꢀ A repetitive pattern from 1 to 32 bits in length
ꢀ Alternating (16-bit) words that flip every 1 to 256 words
ꢀ Daly pattern
The BERT receiver has a 32-bit bit counter and a 24-bit error counter. The BERT receiver reports three
events: a change in receive synchronizer status, a bit error being detected, and if either the bit counter or
the error counter overflows. Each of these events can be masked within the BERT function through the
BERT control register 1 (BC1). If the software detects that the BERT has reported an event, then the
software must read the BERT information register (BIR) to determine which event(s) has occurred. To
activate the BERT block, the host must configure the BERT mux through the BIC register.
26.1Status
SR9 contains the status information on the BERT function. The host can be alerted through this register
when there is a BERT change-of-state. A major change-of-state is defined as either a change in the
receive synchronization (i.e., the BERT has gone into or out of receive synchronization), a bit error has
been detected, or an overflow has occurred in either the bit counter or the error counter. The host must
read status register 9 (SR9) to determine the change-of-state.
26.2Mapping
The BERT function can be assigned to the network direction or backplane direction through the direction
control bit in the BIC register (BIC.1). See Figure 26-1 and Figure 26-2. The BERT also can be assigned
on a per-channel basis. The BERT transmit control selector (BTCS) and BERT receive control selector
(BRCS) bits of the per-channel pointer register (PCPR) are used to map the BERT function into time slots
of the transmit and receive data streams. In T1 mode, the user can enable mapping into the F-bit position
for the transmit and receive directions through the RFUS and TFUS bits in the BERT interface control
(BIC) register.
170 of 238
DS2155
Figure 26-1. Simplified Diagram of BERT in Network Direction
TO RECEIVE
FROM RECEIVE
FRAMER
SYSTEM
BACKPLANE
INTERFACE
PER-CHANNEL AND
F-BIT (T1 MODE)
MAPPING
BERT
BERT
RECEIVER TRANSMITTER
1
0
TO TRANSMIT
FRAMER
FROM TRANSMIT
SYSTEM
BACKPLANE
INTERFACE
Figure 26-2. Simplified Diagram of BERT in Backplane Direction
TO RECEIVE
FROM RECEIVE
FRAMER
0
1
SYSTEM
BACKPLANE
INTERFACE
PER-CHANNEL AND
F-BIT (T1 MODE)
MAPPING
BERT
BERT
RECEIVER
TRANSMITTER
FROM TRANSMIT
SYSTEM
TO TRANSMIT
FRAMER
BACKPLANE
INTERFACE
171 of 238
DS2155
26.3BERT Register Descriptions
Register Name:
BC1
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Control Register 1
E0h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TC
0
6
TINV
0
5
RINV
0
4
PS2
0
3
PS1
0
2
PS0
0
1
LC
0
0
RESYNC
0
Bit 0/Force Resynchronization (RESYNC). A low-to-high transition forces the receive BERT synchronizer to
resynchronize to the incoming data stream. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes
to acquire synchronization on a new pattern. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resynchronization.
Bit 1/Load Bit and Error Counters (LC). A low-to-high transition latches the current bit and error counts into
registers BBC1/BBC2/BBC3/BBC4 and BEC1/BEC2/BEC3 and clears the internal count. This bit should be
toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to begin a new acquisition period. Must be cleared and set
again for subsequent loads.
Bits 2 to 4/Pattern Select Bits (PS0 to PS2)
PS2 PS1 PS0
Pattern Definition
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
Pseudorandom 2E7 - 1
Pseudorandom 2E11 - 1
Pseudorandom 2E15 - 1
Pseudorandom pattern QRSS. A 220 - 1 pattern with 14 consecutive zero
restrictions.
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
Repetitive pattern
Alternating word pattern
Modified 55 octet (Daly) pattern. The Daly pattern is a repeating 55 octet
pattern that is byte-aligned into the active DS0 time slots. The pattern is
defined in an ATIS (Alliance for Telecommunications Industry Solutions)
Committee T1 Technical Report Number 25 (November 1993).
Pseudorandom 2E9 - 1
1
1
1
1
0
1
Bit 5/Receive Invert-Data Enable (RINV)
0 = do not invert the incoming data stream
1 = invert the incoming data stream
Bit 6/Transmit Invert-Data Enable (TINV)
0 = do not invert the outgoing data stream
1 = invert the outgoing data stream
Bit 7/Transmit Pattern Load (TC). A low-to-high transition loads the pattern generator with the pattern that is to
be generated. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to load a new pattern. Must be
cleared and set again for subsequent loads.
172 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
BC2
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Control Register 2
E1h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EIB2
0
6
EIB1
0
5
EIB0
0
4
SBE
0
3
RPL3
0
2
RPL2
0
1
RPL1
0
0
RPL0
0
Bits 0 to 3/Repetitive Pattern Length Bit 3 (RPL0 to RPL3). RPL0 is the LSB and RPL3 is the MSB of a nibble
that describes how long the repetitive pattern is. The valid range is 17 (0000) to 32 (1111). These bits are ignored if
the receive BERT is programmed for a pseudorandom pattern. To create repetitive patterns fewer than 17 bits in
length, the user must set the length to an integer number of the desired length that is less than or equal to 32. For
example, to create a 6-bit pattern, the user can set the length to 18 (0001) or to 24 (0111) or to 30 (1101).
Length
RPL3
RPL2 RPL1 RPL0
(bits)
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Bit 4/Single Bit-Error Insert (SBE). A low-to-high transition creates a single-bit error. Must be cleared and set
again for a subsequent bit error to be inserted.
Bits 5 to 7/Error Insert Bits 0 to 2 (EIB0 to EIB2). Automatically inserts bit errors at the prescribed rate into the
generated data pattern. Can be used for verifying error-detection features.
EIB2
EIB1
EIB0
Error Rate Inserted
No errors automatically inserted
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
10E-1
10E-2
10E-3
10E-4
10E-5
10E-6
10E-7
173 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
SR9
Register Description:
Register Address:
Status Register 9
26h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
BBED
0
5
BBCO
0
4
BEC0
0
3
BRA1
0
2
1
0
BSYNC
0
BRA0 BRLOS
0
0
Bit 0/BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC). Set when the incoming pattern matches for 32 consecutive
bit positions. Refer to BSYNC in the INFO2 register for a real-time version of this bit. This is a double interrupt bit
(Section 6.2).
Bit 1/BERT Receive Loss-of-Synchronization Condition (BRLOS). A latched bit that is set whenever the
receive BERT begins searching for a pattern. Once synchronization is achieved, this bit remains set until read. This
is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).
Bit 2/BERT Receive All-Zeros Condition (BRA0). A latched bit that is set when 32 consecutive 0s are received.
Allowed to be cleared once a 1 is received. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).
Bit 3/BERT Receive All-Ones Condition (BRA1). A latched bit that is set when 32 consecutive 1s are received.
Allowed to be cleared once a 0 is received. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).
Bit 4/BERT Error-Counter Overflow (BECO) Event (BECO). A latched bit that is set when the 24-bit BERT
error counter (BEC) overflows. Cleared when read and is not set again until another overflow occurs.
Bit 5/BERT Bit-Counter Overflow Event (BBCO). A latched bit that is set when the 32-bit BERT bit counter
(BBC) overflows. Cleared when read and is not set again until another overflow occurs.
Bit 6/BERT Bit-Error Detected (BED) Event (BBED). A latched bit that is set when a bit error is detected. The
receive BERT must be in synchronization for it to detect bit errors. Cleared when read.
174 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IMR9
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interrupt Mask Register 9
27h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
BBED
0
5
BBCO
0
4
BEC0
0
3
BRA1
0
2
1
0
BSYNC
0
BRA0 BRLOS
0
0
Bit 0/BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 1/Receive Loss-of-Synchronization Condition (BRLOS)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 2/Receive All-Zeros Condition (BRA0)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 3/Receive All-Ones Condition (BRA1)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges
Bit 4/BERT Error-Counter Overflow Event (BECO)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 5/BERT Bit-Counter Overflow Event (BBCO)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 6/Bit-Error Detected Event (BBED)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
BERT Alternating Word-Count Rate. When the BERT is programmed in the alternating word mode, the words
repeat for the count loaded into this register then flip to the other word and again repeat for the number of times
loaded into this register.
Register Name:
BAWC
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Alternating Word-Count Rate
DBh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ACNT7 ACNT6 ACNT5 ACNT4 ACNT3 ACNT2 ACNT1 ACNT0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Alternating Word-Count Rate Bits 0 to 7 (ACNT0 to ACNT7). ACNT0 is the LSB of the 8-bit
alternating word-count rate counter.
175 of 238
DS2155
26.4 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set
These registers must be properly loaded for the BERT to generate and synchronize to a repetitive pattern,
a pseudorandom pattern, alternating word pattern, or a Daly pattern. For a repetitive pattern that is fewer
than 32 bits, the pattern should be repeated so that all 32 bits are used to describe the pattern. For
example, if the pattern was the repeating 5-bit pattern …01101… (where the rightmost bit is the one sent
first and received first), then BRP1 should be loaded with ADh, BRP2 with B5h, BRP3 with D6h, and
BRP4 with 5Ah. For a pseudorandom pattern, all four registers should be loaded with all 1s (i.e., FFh).
For an alternating word pattern, one word should be placed into BRP1 and BRP2 and the other word
should be placed into BRP3 and BRP4. For example, if the DDS stress pattern “7E” is to be described,
the user would place 00h in BRP1, 00h in BRP2, 7Eh in BRP3, and 7Eh in BRP4 and the alternating
word counter would be set to 50 (decimal) to allow 100 bytes of 00h followed by 100 bytes of 7Eh to be
sent and received.
Register Name:
BRP1
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1
DCh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RPAT0
0
RPAT7 RPAT6 RPAT5 RPAT4 RPAT3 RPAT2 RPAT1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 0 to 7 (RPAT0 to RPAT7). RPAT0 is the LSB of the 32-bit
repetitive pattern set.
Register Name:
BRP2
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2
DDh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RPAT15
0
6
5
4
3
2
RPAT10
0
1
RPAT9
0
0
RPAT8
0
RPAT14 RPAT13 RPAT12 RPAT11
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 8 to 15 (RPAT8 to RPAT15)
Register Name:
BRP3
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3
DEh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RPAT23
0
6
5
4
3
2
RPAT18
0
1
RPAT17
0
0
RPAT16
0
RPAT22 RPAT21 RPAT20 RPAT19
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 16 to 23 (RPAT16 to RPAT23)
Register Name:
BRP4
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4
DFh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RPAT31
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RPAT30 RPAT29 RPAT28 RPAT27 RPAT26 RPAT25 RPAT24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 24 to 31 (RPAT24 to RPAT31). RPAT31 is the LSB of the 32-bit
repetitive pattern set.
176 of 238
DS2155
26.5 BERT Bit Counter
Once BERT has achieved synchronization, this 32-bit counter increments for each data bit (i.e., clock)
received. Toggling the LC control bit in BC1 can clear this counter. This counter saturates when full and
sets the BBCO status bit.
Register Name:
BBC1
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Bit Count Register 1
E3h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
BBC7
0
6
BBC6
0
5
BBC5
0
4
BBC4
0
3
BBC3
0
2
BBC2
0
1
BBC1
0
0
BBC0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 0 to 7 (BBC0 to BBC7). BBC0 is the LSB of the 32-bit counter.
Register Name:
BBC2
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Bit Count Register 2
E4h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
BBC10
0
1
BBC9
0
0
BBC8
0
BBC15 BBC14 BBC13 BBC12 BBC11
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 8 to 15 (BBC8 to BBC15)
Register Name:
BBC3
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Bit Count Register 3
E5h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BBC16
0
BBC23 BBC22 BBC21 BBC20 BBC19
BBC18 BBC17
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 16 to 23 (BBC16 to BBC23)
Register Name:
BBC4
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Bit Count Register 4
E6h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BBC24
0
BBC31 BBC30 BBC29 BBC28 BBC27
BBC26 BBC25
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 24 to 31 (BBC24 to BBC31). BBC31 is the MSB of the 32-bit counter.
177 of 238
DS2155
26.6 BERT Error Counter
Once BERT has achieved synchronization, this 24-bit counter increments for each data bit received in
error. Toggling the LC control bit in BC1 can clear this counter. This counter saturates when full and sets
the BECO status bit.
Register Name:
BEC1
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Error-Count Register 1
E7h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EC7
0
6
EC6
0
5
EC5
0
4
EC4
0
3
EC3
0
2
EC2
0
1
EC1
0
0
EC0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 0 to 7 (EC0 to EC7). EC0 is the LSB of the 24-bit counter.
Register Name:
BEC2
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Error-Count Register 2
E8h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EC15
0
6
EC14
0
5
EC13
0
4
EC12
0
3
EC11
0
2
EC10
0
1
EC9
0
0
EC8
0
Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 8 to 15 (EC8 to EC15)
Register Name:
BEC3
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Error-Count Register 3
E9h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EC23
0
6
EC22
0
5
EC21
0
4
EC20
0
3
EC19
0
2
EC18
0
1
EC17
0
0
EC16
0
Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 16 to 23 (EC16 to EC23). EC0 is the MSB of the 24-bit counter.
178 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
BIC
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Interface Control Register
EAh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
RFUS
0
5
—
0
4
TBAT
0
3
TFUS
0
2
—
0
1
0
BERTDIR BERTEN
0
0
Bit 0/BERT Enable (BERTEN)
0 = BERT disabled
1 = BERT enabled
Bit 1/BERT Direction (BERTDIR)
0 = network
BERT transmits toward the network (TTIP and TRING) and receives from the network (RTIP and
RRING). The BERT pattern can be looped back to the receiver internally by using the framer loopback
function.
1 = system
BERT transmits toward the system backplane (RSER) and receives from the system backplane (TSER).
Bits 2, 5, 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Bit 3/Transmit Framed/Unframed Select (TFUS)
0 = BERT does not source data into the F-bit position (framed)
1 = BERT does source data into the F-bit position (unframed)
Bit 4/Transmit Byte-Align Toggle (TBAT). A 0-to-1 transition forces the BERT to byte align its pattern with the
transmit formatter. This bit must be transitioned in order to byte align the Daly pattern.
Bit 6/Receive Framed/Unframed Select (RFUS)
0 = BERT is not sent data from the F-bit position (framed)
1 = BERT is sent data from the F-bit position (unframed)
179 of 238
DS2155
27. PAYLOAD ERROR-INSERTION FUNCTION (T1 MODE ONLY)
An error-insertion function is available in the DS2155 and is used to create errors in the payload portion
of the T1 frame in the transmit path. This function is only available in T1 mode. Errors can be inserted
over the entire frame or the user can select which channels are to be corrupted. Errors are created by
inverting the last bit in the count sequence. For example, if the error rate 1 in 16 is selected, the 16th bit is
inverted. F-bits are excluded from the count and are never corrupted. Error rate changes occur on frame
boundaries. Error-insertion options include continuous and absolute number with both options supporting
selectable insertion rates.
Table 27-A. Transmit Error-Insertion Setup Sequence
STEP
ACTION
1
Enter desired error rate in the ERC register. Note: If ER3 through ER0 = 0, no errors
are generated even if the constant error-insertion feature is enabled.
For constant error insertion, set CE = 1 (ERC.4).
2A
or
2B
For a defined number of errors:
–
–
–
Set CE = 0 (ERC.4)
Load NOE1 and NOE2 with the number of errors to be inserted
Toggle WNOE (ERC.7) from 0 to 1 to begin error insertion
180 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
ERC
Register Description:
Register Address:
Error-Rate Control Register
EBh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
WNOE
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
CE
0
3
ER3
0
2
ER2
0
1
ER1
0
0
ER0
0
Bits 0 to 3/Error-Insertion Rate Select Bits (ER0 to ER3)
ER3 ER2 ER1 ER0
Error Rate
No errors inserted
1 in 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1 in 32
1 in 64
1 in 128
1 in 256
1 in 512
1 in 1024
1 in 2048
1 in 4096
1 in 8192
1 in 16,384
1 in 32,768
1 in 65,536
1 in 131,072
1 in 262,144
Bit 4/Constant Errors (CE). When this bit is set high (and the ER0 to ER3 bits are not set to 0000), the error-
insertion logic ignores the number-of-error registers (NOE1, NOE2) and generates errors constantly at the selected
insertion rate. When CE is set to 0, the NOEx registers determine how many errors are to be inserted.
Bits 5, 6/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Bit 7/Write NOE Registers (WNOE). If the host wishes to update to the NOEx registers, this bit must be toggled
from a 0 to a 1 after the host has already loaded the prescribed error count into the NOEx registers. The toggling of
this bit causes the error count loaded into the NOEx registers to be loaded into the error-insertion circuitry on the
next clock cycle. Subsequent updates require that the WNOE bit be set to 0 and then 1 once again.
181 of 238
DS2155
27.1Number-of-Errors Registers
The number-of-error registers determine how many errors are generated. Up to 1023 errors can be
generated. The host loads the number of errors to be generated into the NOE1 and NOE2 registers. The
host can also update the number of errors to be created by first loading the prescribed value into the NOE
registers and then toggling the WNOE bit in the error-rate control registers.
Table 27-B. Error Insertion Examples
VALUE
WRITE
READ
000h
001h
002h
3FFh
Do not create any errors
Create a single error
Create two errors
No errors left to be inserted
One error left to be inserted
Two errors left to be inserted
1023 errors left to be inserted
Create 1023 errors
Register Name:
NOE1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Number-of-Errors 1
ECh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Number-of-Errors Counter Bits 0 to 7 (C0 to C7). Bit C0 is the LSB of the 10-bit counter.
Register Name:
NOE2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Number-of-Errors 2
EDh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
C9
0
0
C8
0
Bits 0, 1/Number-of-Errors Counter Bits 8 to 9 (C8 to C9). Bit C9 is the MSB of the 10-bit counter.
182 of 238
DS2155
27.1.1 Number-of-Errors Left Register
The host can read the NOELx registers at any time to determine how many errors are left to be inserted.
Register Name:
NOEL1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Number-of-Errors Left 1
EEh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Number-of-Errors Left Counter Bits 0 to 7 (C0 to C7). Bit C0 is the LSB of the 10-bit counter.
Register Name:
NOEL2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Number-of-Errors Left 2
EFh
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
C9
0
0
C8
0
Bits 0, 1/Number-of-Errors Left Counter Bits 8 to 9 (C8 to C9). Bit C9 is the MSB of the 10-bit counter.
183 of 238
DS2155
28. INTERLEAVED PCM BUS OPERATION (IBO)
In many architectures, the PCM outputs of individual framers are combined into higher speed PCM buses
to simplify transport across the system backplane. The DS2155 can be configured to allow PCM data to
be multiplexed into higher speed buses eliminating external hardware, saving board space and cost. The
DS2155 can be configured for channel or frame interleave.
The interleaved PCM bus operation (IBO) supports three bus speeds. The 4.096MHz bus speed allows
two PCM data streams to share a common bus. The 8.192MHz bus speed allows four PCM data streams
to share a common bus. The 16.384MHz bus speed allows eight PCM data streams to share a common
bus. See Figure 28-1 for an example of four transceivers sharing a common 8.192MHz PCM bus. The
receive elastic stores of each transceiver must be enabled. Through the IBO register, the user can
configure each transceiver for a specific bus position. For all IBO bus configurations, each transceiver is
assigned an exclusive position in the high-speed PCM bus. The 8kHz frame sync can be generated from
the system backplane or from the first device on the bus. All other devices on the bus must have their
frame syncs configured as inputs. Relative to this common frame sync, the devices await their turn to
drive or sample the bus according to the settings of the DA0, DA1, and DA2 bits of the IBOC register.
28.1Channel Interleave
In channel interleave mode, data is output to the PCM data-out bus one channel at a time from each of the
connected DS2155s until all channels of frame n from each DS2155 have been placed on the bus. This
mode can be used even when the DS2155s are operating asynchronous to each other. The elastic stores
manage slip conditions (Figure 35-22).
28.2Frame Interleave
In frame interleave mode, data is output to the PCM data-out bus one frame at a time from each of the
DS2155s. This mode is used only when all connected DS2155s are operating in a synchronous fashion
(all inbound T1 or E1 lines are synchronous) and are synchronous with the system clock (system clock
derived from T1 or E1 line). Slip conditions are not allowed in this mode (Figure 35-23).
184 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
IBOC
Register Description:
Register Address:
Interleave Bus Operation Control Register
C5h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
IBS1
0
5
IBS0
0
4
3
2
1
DA1
0
0
DA0
0
IBOSEL IBOEN DA2
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Device Assignment Bits (DA0 to DA2)
DA2
DA1
DA0
Device Position on Bus
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1st
2nd
3rd
4th
5th
6th
7th
8th
Bit 3/Interleave Bus Operation Enable (IBOEN)
0 = IBO disabled
1 = IBO enabled
Bit 4/Interleave Bus Operation Select (IBOSEL). This bit selects channel or frame interleave mode.
0 = channel interleave
1 = frame interleave
Bits 5, 6/IBO Bus Size Bit 1 (IBS0 to IBS1). Indicates how many devices are on the bus.
IBS1
IBS0
Bus Size
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Two devices on bus
Four devices on bus
Eight devices on bus
Reserved for future use
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
185 of 238
DS2155
Figure 28-1. IBO Example
RSYSCLK
TSYSCLK
RSYSCLK
TSYSCLK
RSYNC
RSYNC
TSSYNC
TSSYNC
RSIG
TSIG
RSIG
TSIG
TSER
TSER
RSER
RSER
DS2155 #1
DS2155 #3
8.192MHz SYSTEM CLOCK IN
SYSTEM 8kHz FRAME SYNC IN
PCM SIGNALING OUT
PCM SIGNALING IN
PCM DATA IN
PCM DATA OUT
RSYSCLK
TSYSCLK
RSYSCLK
TSYSCLK
RSYNC
RSYNC
TSSYNC
TSSYNC
RSIG
TSIG
RSIG
TSIG
TSER
TSER
RSER
RSER
DS2155 #2
DS2155 #4
186 of 238
DS2155
29. EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS (ESIB)
The extended system information bus (ESIB) allows up to eight DS2155s to share an 8-bit CPU bus for
reporting alarms and interrupt status as a group. With a single bus read, the host can be updated with
alarm or interrupt status from all members of the group. There are two control registers (ESIBCR1 and
ESIBCR2) and four information registers (ESIB1, ESIB2, ESIB3, and ESIB4). For example, eight
DS2155s can be grouped into an ESIB group. A single read of the ESIB1 register of any member of the
group yields the interrupt status of all eight DS2155s. Therefore, the host can determine which device or
devices are causing an interrupt without polling all eight devices. Through ESIB2, the host can gather
synchronization status on all members of the group. ESIB3 and ESIB4 can be programmed to report
various alarms on a device-by-device basis.
There are three device pins involved in forming an ESIB group: ESIBS0, ESIBS1, and ESIBRD. A 10kΩ
pullup resistor must be provided on ESIBS0, ESIBS1, and ESIBRD.
Figure 29-1. ESIB Group of Four DS2155s
VDD
10kΩ (3)
DS2155 # 1
ESIB0
CPU I/F
ESIB1
ESIBRD
DS2155 # 2
ESIB0
ESIB1
CPU I/F
ESIBRD
DS2155 # 3
ESIB0
ESIB1
CPU I/F
ESIBRD
DS2155 # 4
ESIB0
ESIB1
CPU I/F
ESIBRD
187 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
ESIBCR1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Extended System Information Bus Control Register 1
B0h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
2
1
0
ESIBSEL2 ESIBSEL1 ESIBSEL0 ESIEN
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Extended System Information Bus Enable (ESIEN)
0 = disabled
1 = enabled
Bits 1 to 3/Output Data Bus Line Select (ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2). These bits tell the DS2155 what data bus
bit to output the ESIB data on when one of the ESIB information registers is accessed. Each member of the ESIB
group must have a unique bit selected.
ESIBSEL2 ESIBSEL1 ESIBSEL0
Bus Bit Driven
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
AD0
AD1
AD2
AD3
AD4
AD5
AD6
AD7
Bits 4 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
188 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
ESIBCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Extended System Information Bus Control Register 2
B1h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
6
5
4
3
—
0
2
1
0
ESI4SEL2 ESI4SEL1 ESI4SEL0
ESI3SEL2 ESI3SEL1 ESI3SEL0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Address ESI3 Data Output Select (ESI3SEL0 to ESI3SEL2). These bits select what status is to be
output when the DS2155 decodes an ESI3 address during a bus read operation.
Status Output
(T1 Mode)
RBL
Status Output
(E1 Mode)
RUA1
ESI3SEL2 ESI3SEL1 ESI3SEL0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
RYEL
LUP
RRA
RDMA
V52LNK
SIGCHG
ESSLIP
—
LDN
SIGCHG
ESSLIP
—
—
—
Bit 3/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Bits 4 to 6/Address ESI4 Data-Output Select (ESI4SEL0 to ESI4SEL2). These bits select what status is to be
output when the DS2155 decodes an ESI4 address during a bus read operation.
Status Output
(T1 Mode)
RBL
Status Output
(E1 Mode)
RUA1
ESI4SEL2 ESI4SEL1 ESI4SEL0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
RYEL
LUP
RRA
RDMA
V52LNK
SIGCHG
ESSLIP
—
LDN
SIGCHG
ESSLIP
—
—
—
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
189 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
ESIB1
Register Description:
Register Address:
Extended System Information Bus Register 1
B2h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
DISn
0
6
DISn
0
5
DISn
0
4
DISn
0
3
DISn
0
2
DISn
0
1
DISn
0
0
DISn
0
Bits 0 to 7/Device Interrupt Status (DISn). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output their
interrupt status on the appropriate data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR1
register.
Register Name:
ESIB2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Extended System Information Bus Register 2
B3h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Device Receive Loss-of-Sync (DRLOSn). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output
their frame synchronization status on the appropriate data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of
the ESIBCR1 register.
Register Name:
ESIB3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Extended System Information Bus Register 3
B4h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
UST1n
0
6
UST1n
0
5
UST1n
0
4
UST1n
0
3
UST1n
0
2
UST1n
0
1
UST1n
0
0
UST1n
0
Bits 0 to 7/User-Selected Status 1 (UST1n). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output status or
alarms as selected by the ESI3SEL0 to ESI3SEL2 bits in the ESIBCR2 configuration register on the appropriate
data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR2 register
Register Name:
ESIB4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Extended System Information Bus Register 4
B5h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
UST2n
0
6
UST2n
0
5
UST2n
0
4
UST2n
0
3
UST2n
0
2
UST2n
0
1
UST2n
0
0
UST2n
0
Bits 0 to 7/User-Selected Status 2 (UST2n). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output status or
alarms as selected by the ESI4SEL0 to ESI4SEL2 bits in the ESIBCR2 configuration register on the appropriate
data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR2 register
190 of 238
DS2155
30. PROGRAMMABLE BACKPLANE CLOCK SYNTHESIZER
The DS2155 contains an on-chip clock synthesizer that generates a user-selectable clock output on the
BPCLK pin, referenced to the recovered receive clock (RCLK). The synthesizer uses a phase-locked loop
to generate low-jitter clocks. Common applications include generation of port and backplane system
clocks. The CCR2 register is used to enable (CCR2.0) and select (CCR2.1 and CCR2.2) the clock
frequency of the BPCLK pin.
Register Name:
CCR2
Register Description:
Register Address:
Common Control Register 2
71h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
BPCS1
0
1
BPCS0
0
0
BPEN
0
Bit 0/Backplane Clock Enable (BPEN)
0 = disable BPCLK pin (pin held at logic 0)
1 = enable BPCLK pin
Bits 1, 2/Backplane Clock Selects (BPCS0, BPCS1)
BPCS1
BPCS0
BPCLK Frequency (MHz)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
16.384
8.192
4.096
2.048
Bits 3 to 7/ Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
31. FRACTIONAL T1/E1 SUPPORT
The DS2155 can be programmed to output gapped clocks for selected channels in the receive and
transmit paths to simplify connections into a USART or LAPD controller in fractional T1/E1 or ISDN-
PRI applications. The receive and transmit paths have independent enables. Channel formats supported
include 56kbps and 64kbps. This is accomplished by assigning an alternate function to the RCHCLK and
TCHCLK pins. Setting CCR3.0 = 1 causes the RCHCLK pin to output a gapped clock as defined by the
receive fractional T1/E1 function of the PCPR register. Setting CCR3.2 = 1 causes the TCHCLK pin to
output a gapped clock as defined by the transmit fractional T1/E1 function of the PCPR register. CCR3.1
and CCR3.3 can be used to select between 64kbps and 56kbps operation. See Section 7 for details about
programming the per-channel function. In T1 mode no clock is generated at the F-bit position.
When 56kbps mode is selected, the LSB clock in the channel is omitted. Only the seven most significant
bits of the channel have clocks.
191 of 238
DS2155
Register Name:
CCR3
Register Description:
Register Address:
Common Control Register 3
72h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
-
0
4
-
0
3
2
1
0
TMSS INTDIS
TDATFMT TGPCKEN
RDATFMT
0
RGPCKEN
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Gapped-Clock Enable (RGPCKEN)
0 = RCHCLK functions normally
1 = enable gapped bit-clock output on RCHCLK
Bit 1/Receive Channel-Data Format (RDATFMT)
0 = 64kbps (data contained in all 8 bits)
1 = 56kbps (data contained in seven out of the 8 bits)
Bit 2/Transmit Gapped-Clock Enable (TGPCKEN)
0 = TCHCLK functions normally
1 = enable gapped bit-clock output on TCHCLK
Bit 3/Transmit Channel-Data Format (TDATFMT)
0 = 64kbps (data contained in all 8 bits)
1 = 56kbps (data contained in seven out of the 8 bits)
Bit 4/ Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Bit 5/ Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation
Bit 6/Interrupt Disable (INTDIS). This bit is convenient for disabling interrupts without altering the various
interrupt mask register settings.
0 = interrupts are enabled according to the various mask register settings
1 = interrupts are disabled regardless of the mask register settings
Bit 7/Transmit Multiframe Sync Source (TMSS). Should be set = 0 only when transmit hardware signaling is
enabled.
0 = elastic store is source of multiframe sync
1 = framer or TSYNC pin is source of multiframe sync
192 of 238
DS2155
32. USER-PROGRAMMABLE OUTPUT PINS
The DS2155 provides four user-programmable output pins. The pins are automatically cleared to 0 at
power-up or as a result of a hardware- or software-issued reset.
Register Name:
CCR4
Register Description:
Register Address:
Common Control Register 4
73h
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RLT3
0
6
RLT2
0
5
RLT1
0
4
RLT0
0
3
UOP3
0
2
UOP2
0
1
UOP1
0
0
UOP0
0
Bit 0/User-Defined Output 0 (UOP0)
0 = logic 0 level at pin
1 = logic 1 level at pin
Bit 1/User-Defined Output 1 (UOP1)
0 = logic 0 level at pin
1 = logic 1 level at pin
Bit 2/User-Defined Output 2 (UOP2)
0 = logic 0 level at pin
1 = logic 1 level at pin
Bit 3/User-Defined Output 3 (UOP3)
0 = logic 0 level at pin
1 = logic 1 level at pin
Bits 4 to 7/Receive Level Threshold Bits (RLT0 to RLT3)
RLT3
RLT2
RLT1
RLT0
Receive Level (dB)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Greater than -2.5
-2.5
-5.0
-7.5
-10.0
-12.5
-15.0
-17.5
-20.0
-22.5
-25.0
-27.5
-30.0
-32.5
-35.0
Less than -37.5
193 of 238
DS2155
33. TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAMS
Figure 33-1. T1 Transmit Flow Diagram
TSER
TSIG
T1 TRANSMIT
FLOW
Hardware
Signaling
HSIE1-3
through
PCPR
DIAGRAM
TX
ESTORE
KEY
Estore Mux
ESCR.4 TESE
- PIN
- SELECTOR
- REGISTER
TESO
Off-Chip
RDATA
From
Connection
T1_rcv_logic
TDATA
Payload
Loopback
LBCR1.1 PLB
HDLC
Engine
#1
TLINK
THMS1 H1TC.4
H1TCS1-3
H1TC.4
THMS1
HDLC FDL #1
HDLC Mux #1
H1TTSBS
HDLC
Engine
#2
THMS2 H2TC.4
H2TCS1-3
H2TC.4
THMS2
HDLC Mux #2
HDLC FDL #2
TFDL
H2TTSBS
Idle
Code
Array
Tx FDL
Zero
T1TCR2.5
TZSE
Stuffer
TCICE1-3
Idle Code Mux
T1TCR1.2
TFDLS
TFDL
FDL Mux
Loop
Code
Gen
BOC
Engine
Loop Code
TLOOP T1CCR1.0
BOC Mux
BOCC.0 SBOC
T1CCR1.2 TFM
T1TCR2.2 TD4YM
T1TCR1.0 TYEL
D4 12th Fs
Yellow
Per-Channel
PCLR1-3
Loopback
alarm
Software
Sig
Registers
FPS or
ESF Yellow
Ft/Fs
SSIE1-3
Alarm
Software Sig
insertion
F-bit Mux
To FDL Mux
TFPT T1TCR1.5
To ESF Yellow
Mux
To FDL Mux
194 of 238
DS2155
From ESF
From BOC Mux
From F-bit Mux
Yellow Alarm
TFPT T1TCR1.5
FDL Mux
TFM T1CCR1.2
TYEL T1TCR1.0
ESF Yellow
CRC Mux
TCPT T1TCR1.5
D4 bit 2
Yellow
Alm
TFM T1CCR1.2
BERT
TD4YM T1TCR2.2
TYEL T1TCR1.0
Engine
TFUS BIC.3
F-bit
BERT Mux
BERTEN
BIC.0
BTCS1-3
from PCPR
T1TCR2.3 FBCT1
T1TCR2.4 FBCT2
F-bit
Corruption
Payload
error
NOEL != 0
ERC.4 CE
insertion
SSIE1-3
GB7S T1TCR1.3
PEICS1-3
Bit 7
stuffing
B7SE T1TCR2.0
Pulse
Density
Enforcer
T1CCR1.1 PDE
TPDV INFO1.6
CRC
DS0
TCM0-4 TDS0SEL.0 - .3
TDSOM
Calculation
Monitor
B8ZS
Encoding
T1TCR2.7 B8ZSE
Blue
T1TCR1.1 TBL
Alarm
Bipolar/
NRZ
IOCR1.0 ODF
coding
1/2 CLK/
CCR1.4 ODM
FULL CLK
TPOS
TNEG
195 of 238
DS2155
Figure 33-2. E1 Transmit Flow Diagram
TSER
TSIG
E1 TRANSMIT
FLOW
Hardware
HSIE1-4
DIAGRAM
Signaling
through
PCPR
TX
ESTORE
Estore Mux
TESO
ESCR.4 TESE
Off-Chip
Connection
TDATA
RDATA
From
E1_rcv_logic
Payload
LBCR1.1 PLB
HDLC
Engine
#1
Loopback Mux
THMS1 H1TC.4
H1TCS1-4
HDLC DS0
Mux #1
H1TTSBS
THMS1 H1TC.4
HDLC Sa-bit
Mux #1
T1SaBE4-
H1TTSBS.4 - H1TTSBS.0
T1SaBE8
HDLC
Engine #2
THMS2 H2TC.4
H2TCS1-4
HDLC DS0
Mux #2
H2TTSBS
KEY
- PIN
THMS2 H2TC.4
HDLC Sa-bit
Mux #2
T2SaBE4-T2SaBE8
H2TTSBS.4 - H2TTSBS.0
BERT
Engine
- SELECTOR
- REGISTER
BERTEN (BIC.0)
BERT Mux
BTCS1-4
from PCPR
Idle Code
Array
TCICE1-4
Idle Code MUX
To Per-Channel Mux
196 of 238
DS2155
From Idle
Code Mux
RDATA
From E1_rcv_logic
E1 TRANSMIT
Per-Channel
Loopback
FLOW
PCLR1-4
TNAF
DIAGRAM
H1TC.4
H2TC.4
THMS1
THMS2
Sa-bit Mux
TAF/TNAF(non Sa)
TS0 Mux
TFPT E1TCR1.7
Si-bit Mux
E1TCR1.4 TSIS
Si = CRC4 MF Align Word
(Does not overwrite E-bits)
E1TCR1.0 TCRC4
E1TCR2.2 AEBE
Si/CRC4 Mux
TLINK
Auto E-
bit Gen
TLINK Mux
Sa4S - Sa8S
E1TCR2.5 - E1TCR2.7
TSiAF
TSiNAF
TRA
TSa5
TSa6
TSa7
TSa8
Auto
E1TCR2.8 ARA
RA Gen
TSa4
TSaCR Mux
TSaCR
TS1-16
TSA1 E1TCR1.3
SSIE1-4
Software Sig
E1TCR1.0 T16S
CRC
E1TCR1.0 TCRC4
Calculate
TDS0SEL.0 - TDS0SEL.4
TCM0-TCM4
CRC Re-
calculate
CCR1.6 CRC4R
E1TCR2.1 AAIS
DS0
TDSOM
Monitor
Auto
AIS
Gen
UA1
Gen
E1TCR1.5 TUA1
E1TCR1.2 THDB3
HDB3
Encoding
To Bipolar/NRZ
coding Mux
197 of 238
DS2155
From HDB3
Encoding Mux
E1 TRANSMIT
FLOW
FLB LBCR1.0
Bipolar/
NRZ
DIAGRAM
IOCR1.0 ODF
coding
FLB
TO RECEIVER
Select
RPOS
RNEG
RLB Mux
RLB Mux
RLB
LBCR1.2
1/2 CLK/
CCR1.4 ODM
FULL CLK
TPOS
TNEG
198 of 238
DS2155
34. JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN ARCHITECTURE AND TEST ACCESS PORT
34.1 Description
The DS2155 IEEE 1149.1 design supports the standard instruction codes SAMPLE/PRELOAD,
BYPASS, and EXTEST. Optional public instructions included are HIGH-Z, CLAMP, and IDCODE
(Figure 34-1.). The DS2155 contains the following features as required by IEEE 1149.1 standard test
access port (TAP) and boundary scan architecture.
ꢀ Test Access Port
ꢀ TAP Controller
ꢀ Instruction Register
ꢀ Bypass Register
ꢀ Boundary Scan Register
ꢀ Device Identification Register
The DS2155 is pin-compatible with the DS2152, DS21x52 (T1) and DS2154, DS21x54 (E1) SCT
families. The JTAG feature uses pins that had no function in the DS2152 and DS2154. Details about
boundary scan architecture and the TAP are in IEEE 1149.1-1990, IEEE 1149.1a-1993, and IEEE
1149.1b-1994. NOTE: JTAG functionality is production tested at 25C only.
The TAP contains the necessary interface pins JTRST, JTCLK, JTMS, JTDI, and JTDO. See the pin
descriptions in Section 4 for details.
Figure 34-1. JTAG Functional Block Diagram
BOUNDARY SCAN
REGISTER
IDENTIFICATION
REGISTER
BYPASS
REGISTER
MUX
INSTRUCTION
REGISTER
SELECT
TEST ACCESS PORT
OUTPUT ENABLE
+V
+V
+V
10kΩ
10kΩ
10kΩ
JTDO
JTDI
JTMS
JTCLK
JTRST
199 of 238
DS2155
TAP Controller State Machine
The TAP controller is a finite state machine that responds to the logic level at JTMS on the rising edge of
JTCLK (Figure 34-2).
Test-Logic-Reset
Upon power-up, the TAP controller is in the Test-Logic-Reset state. The instruction register contains the
IDCODE instruction. All system logic of the device operates normally.
Run-Test-Idle
The Run-Test-Idle is used between scan operations or during specific tests. The instruction register and
test registers remain idle.
Select-DR-Scan
All test registers retain their previous state. With JTMS LOW, a rising edge of JTCLK moves the
controller into the Capture-DR state and initiates a scan sequence. JTMS HIGH during a rising edge on
JTCLK moves the controller to the Select-IR-Scan state.
Capture-DR
Data can be parallel-loaded into the test data registers selected by the current instruction. If the instruction
does not call for a parallel load or the selected register does not allow parallel loads, the test register
remains at its current value. On the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller goes to the Shift-DR state if
JTMS is LOW or it goes to the Exit1-DR state if JTMS is HIGH.
Shift-DR
The test data register selected by the current instruction is connected between JTDI and JTDO and shifts
data one stage toward its serial output on each rising edge of JTCLK. If a test register selected by the
current instruction is not placed in the serial path, it maintains its previous state.
Exit1-DR
While in this state, a rising edge on JTCLK puts the controller in the Update-DR state, which terminates
the scanning process, if JTMS is HIGH. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in
the Pause-DR state.
Pause-DR
Shifting of the test registers is halted while in this state. All test registers selected by the current
instruction retain their previous state. The controller remains in this state while JTMS is LOW. A rising
edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH puts the controller in the Exit2-DR state.
Exit2-DR
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH while in this state puts the controller in the Update-DR state
and terminates the scanning process. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW enters the Shift-DR state.
Update-DR
A falling edge on JTCLK while in the Update-DR state latches the data from the shift register path of the
test registers into the data output latches. This prevents changes at the parallel output because of changes
in the shift register.
200 of 238
DS2155
Select-IR-Scan
All test registers retain their previous state. The instruction register remains unchanged during this state.
With JTMS LOW, a rising edge on JTCLK moves the controller into the Capture-IR state and initiates a
scan sequence for the instruction register. JTMS HIGH during a rising edge on JTCLK puts the controller
back into the Test-Logic-Reset state.
Capture-IR
The Capture-IR state is used to load the shift register in the instruction register with a fixed value. This
value is loaded on the rising edge of JTCLK. If JTMS is HIGH on the rising edge of JTCLK, the
controller enters the Exit1-IR state. If JTMS is LOW on the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller enters
the Shift-IR state.
Shift-IR
In this state, the shift register in the instruction register is connected between JTDI and JTDO and shifts
data one stage for every rising edge of JTCLK toward the serial output. The parallel register and all test
registers remain at their previous states. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH moves the controller
to the Exit1-IR state. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW keeps the controller in the Shift-IR state
while moving data one stage through the instruction shift register.
Exit1-IR
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Pause-IR state. If JTMS is HIGH on
the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller enters the Update-IR state and terminates the scanning process.
Pause-IR
Shifting of the instruction shift register is halted temporarily. With JTMS HIGH, a rising edge on JTCLK
puts the controller in the Exit2-IR state. The controller remains in the Pause-IR state if JTMS is LOW
during a rising edge on JTCLK.
Exit2-IR
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Update-IR state. The controller loops
back to Shift-IR if JTMS is HIGH during a rising edge of JTCLK in this state.
Update-IR
The instruction code shifted into the instruction shift register is latched into the parallel output on the
falling edge of JTCLK as the controller enters this state. Once latched, this instruction becomes the
current instruction. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Run-Test-Idle
state. With JTMS HIGH, the controller enters the Select-DR-Scan state.
201 of 238
DS2155
Figure 34-2. TAP Controller State Diagram
Test Logic
1
Reset
0
1
1
1
Run Test/
Select
Select
0
Idle
DR-Scan
IR-Scan
0
0
1
1
Capture DR
Capture IR
0
0
Shift DR
Shift IR
0
1
0
1
1
1
Exit DR
Exit IR
0
0
Pause DR
Pause IR
0
0
1
1
0
0
Exit2 DR
Exit2 IR
1
1
Update DR
Update IR
1
0
1
0
34.2Instruction Register
The instruction register contains a shift register as well as a latched parallel output and is 3 bits in length.
When the TAP controller enters the Shift-IR state, the instruction shift register is connected between JTDI
and JTDO. While in the Shift-IR state, a rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW shifts the data one stage
toward the serial output at JTDO. A rising edge on JTCLK in the Exit1-IR state or the Exit2-IR state with
JTMS HIGH moves the controller to the Update-IR state. The falling edge of that same JTCLK latches
the data in the instruction shift register to the instruction parallel output. Instructions supported by the
DS2155 and its respective operational binary codes are shown in Table 17-A.
202 of 238
DS2155
Table 34-A. Instruction Codes for IEEE 1149.1 Architecture
INSTRUCTION
SELECTED REGISTER
INSTRUCTION CODES
SAMPLE/PRELOAD
BYPASS
Boundary Scan
Bypass
010
111
000
011
100
001
EXTEST
Boundary Scan
Bypass
CLAMP
HIGHZ
Bypass
Device Identification
IDCODE
SAMPLE/PRELOAD
This is a mandatory instruction for the IEEE 1149.1 specification that supports two functions. The digital
I/Os of the device can be sampled at the boundary scan register without interfering with the normal
operation of the device by using the Capture-DR state. SAMPLE/PRELOAD also allows the device to
shift data into the boundary scan register through JTDI using the Shift-DR state.
BYPASS
When the BYPASS instruction is latched into the parallel instruction register, JTDI connects to JTDO
through the 1-bit bypass test register. This allows data to pass from JTDI to JTDO without affecting the
device’s normal operation.
EXTEST
This allows testing of all interconnections to the device. When the EXTEST instruction is latched in the
instruction register, the following actions occur: Once enabled through the Update-IR state, the parallel
outputs of all digital output pins are driven. The boundary scan register is connected between JTDI and
JTDO. The Capture-DR samples all digital inputs into the boundary scan register.
CLAMP
All digital outputs of the device output data from the boundary scan parallel output while connecting the
bypass register between JTDI and JTDO. The outputs do not change during the CLAMP instruction.
HIGHZ
All digital outputs of the device are placed in a high-impedance state. The BYPASS register is connected
between JTDI and JTDO.
IDCODE
When the IDCODE instruction is latched into the parallel instruction register, the identification test
register is selected. The device identification code is loaded into the identification register on the rising
edge of JTCLK following entry into the Capture-DR state. Shift-DR can be used to shift the identification
code out serially through JTDO. During Test-Logic-Reset, the identification code is forced into the
instruction register’s parallel output. The ID code always has a 1 in the LSB position. The next 11 bits
identify the manufacturer’s JEDEC number and number of continuation bytes followed by 16 bits for the
device and 4 bits for the version (Table 34-B). Table 34-C lists the device ID codes for the SCT devices.
203 of 238
DS2155
Table 34-B. ID Code Structure
MSB
LSB
Version
Device ID
16 bits
JEDEC
1
1
Contact Factory
4 bits
00010100001
Table 34-C. Device ID Codes
PART
16-BIT ID
DS2155
0010h
0019h
0005h
0003h
0004h
0002h
DS2156
DS21354
DS21554
DS21352
DS21552
34.3 Test Registers
IEEE 1149.1 requires a minimum of two test registers, the boundary scan register and the bypass register.
An optional test register, the identification register, has been included with the DS2155 design. It is used
with the IDCODE instruction and the Test-Logic-Reset state of the TAP controller.
34.4 Boundary Scan Register
This register contains both a shift register path and a latched parallel output for all control cells and digital
I/O cells. It is n bits in length. See Table 34-D for cell bit locations and definitions.
34.5 Bypass Register
This is a single one-bit shift register used with the BYPASS, CLAMP, and HIGH-Z instructions that
provides a short path between JTDI and JTDO.
34.6 Identification Register
The identification register contains a 32-bit shift register and a 32-bit latched parallel output. This register
is selected during the IDCODE instruction and when the TAP controller is in the Test-Logic-Reset state.
See Table 34-B and Table 34-C for more information on bit usage.
204 of 238
DS2155
Table 34-D. Boundary Scan Control Bits
BIT
PIN
NAME
TYPE
CONTROL BIT FUNCTION
3
—
1
2
RCHBLK
JTMS
O
I
—
—
0 = BPCLK is an input
2
—
BPCLK.cntl
—
1 = BPCLK is an output
1
3
4
5
6
7
BPCLK
JTCLK
JTRST
RCL
I/O
I
I
O
I
—
—
—
0
—
—
—
—
JTDI
—
0 = UOP0 is an input
98
97
96
95
—
8
UOP0.cntl
UOP0
—
I/O
—
1 = UOP0 is an output
—
0 = UOP1 is an input
—
UOP1.cntl
1 = UOP1 is an output
9
10
11
UOP1
JTDO
BTS
I/O
O
I
—
—
94
93
—
0 = LIUC is an input
—
LIUC.cntl
—
1 = LIUC is an output
92
91
90
89
—
—
—
—
—
—
12
LIUC
8XCLK
TSTRST
UOP2
I/O
O
I
—
13
—
14
—
15
O
I
I
—
16
RTIP
—
17
18
RRING
RVDD
RVSS
—
—
—
I
—
19, 20, 24
21
—
MCLK
XTALD
—
22
O
—
0 = UOP3 is an input
1 = UOP3 is an output
88
—
UOP3.cntl
—
87
86
85
—
—
—
—
—
23
25
UOP3
INT
I/O
O
—
—
26
TUSEL
N.C.
I
—
27, 28
29
—
O
—
—
O
—
TTIP
—
30
TVSS
TVDD
TRING
—
31
—
32
—
0 = TCHBLK is an input
84
83
82
—
33
—
TCHBLK.cntl
TCHBLK
—
I/O
—
1 = TCHBLK is an output
—
0 = TLCLK is an input
TLCLK.cntl
1 = TLCLK is an output
81
80
34
35
TLCLK
TLINK
I/O
I
—
—
0 = ESIBS0 is an input
79
78
77
—
36
—
ESIBS0.cntl
ESIBS0
—
I/O
—
1 = ESIBS0 is an output
—
0 = TSYNC is an input
TSYNC.cntl
1 = TSYNC is an output
76
75
37
38
TSYNC
TPOSI
I/O
I
—
—
205 of 238
DS2155
BIT
PIN
NAME
TYPE
CONTROL BIT FUNCTION
74
73
39
40
TNEGI
TCLKI
I
I
—
—
0 = TCLKO is an input
1 = TCLKO is an output
72
71
70
69
68
—
41
—
42
—
TCLKO.cntl
TCLKO
—
I/O
—
0 = TNEGO is an input
1 = TNEGO is an output
TNEGO.cntl
TNEGO
I/O
—
0 = TPOSO is an input
TPOSO.cntl
1 = TPOSO is an output
67
—
—
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
TPOSO
DVDD
DVSS
I/O
—
—
I
—
—
—
TCLK
—
TSER
I
I
—
TSIG
—
TESO
O
I
—
TDATA
TSYSCLK
TSSYNC
—
I
I
—
—
0 = TCHCLK is an input
59
58
57
—
53
—
TCHCLK.cntl
TCHCLK
—
I/O
—
1 = TCHCLK is an output
—
0 = ESIBS1 is an input
ESIBS1.cntl
1 = ESIBS1 is an output
56
55
54
55
ESIBS1
MUX
I/O
I
—
—
0 = D0–D7/AD0–AD7 are inputs
54
—
BUS.cntl
—
1 = D0–D7/AD0–AD7 are inputs
53
52
51
50
—
—
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
56
D0/AD0
D1/AD1
D2/AD2
D3/AD3
DVSS
DVDD
D4/AD4
D5/AD5
D6/AD6
D7/AD7
A0
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
—
—
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I
—
57
—
58
—
59
—
60, 80, 84
—
61, 81, 83
62
—
—
63
—
64
—
65
—
66
—
67
A1
I
—
68
A2
I
—
69
A3
I
—
70
A4
I
—
71
A5
I
—
72
A6
I
—
73
ALE(AS)/A7
RD (DS)
CS
I
—
—
74
I
—
75
I
0 = ESIBRD is an input
35
—
ESIBRD.cntl
—
1 = ESIBRD is an output
34
33
32
31
76
77
78
79
ESIBRD
WR (R/W)
RLINK
I/O
I
O
O
—
—
—
—
RLCLK
206 of 238
DS2155
BIT
PIN
NAME
TYPE
CONTROL BIT FUNCTION
30
29
82
85
RCLK
O
O
—
—
RDATA
0 = RPOSI is an input
28
27
26
25
24
—
86
—
87
—
RPOSI.cntl
RPOSI
—
I/O
—
1 = RPOSI is an output
—
0 = RNEGI is an input
RNEGI.cntl
RNEGI
1 = RNEGI is an output
I/O
—
—
0 = RCLKI is an input
RCLKI.cntl
1 = RCLKI is an output
23
22
21
20
88
89
90
91
RCLKI
RCLKO
RNEGO
RPOSO
I/O
O
O
O
—
—
—
—
0 = RCHCLK is an input
19
18
17
16
15
—
92
—
93
—
RCHCLK.cntl
RCHCLK
RSIGF.cntl
RSIGF
I/O
I/O
—
1 = RCHCLK is an output
—
0 = RSIGF is an input
1 = RSIGF is an output
I/O
—
—
0 = RSIG is an input
RSIG.cntl
1 = RSIG is an output
14
13
12
11
94
95
—
96
RSIG
RSER
RMSYNC.cntl
RMSYNC
I/O
O
—
I/O
—
—
0 = RMSYNC is an input
—
0 = RFSYNC is an input
10
9
—
97
—
RFSYNC.cntl
RFSYNC
—
I/O
—
1 = RFSYNC is an output
—
0 = RSYNC is an input
8
RSYNC.cntl
1 = RSYNC is an output
7
6
98
99
RSYNC
RLOS/LOTC
I/O
O
—
—
0 = RSYSCLK is an input
1 = RSYSCLK in an output
—
5
4
—
RSYSCLK.cntl
RSYSCLK
—
100
I/O
207 of 238
DS2155
35. FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS
35.1 T1 Mode
Figure 35-1. Receive-Side D4 Timing
1
FRAME#
RFSYNC
RSYNC1
RSYNC 2
RSYNC3
RLCLK
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12
1
2
3
4
5
RLINK 4
Note 1: RSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.6 = 0).
Note 2: RSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.6 = 1).
Note 3: RSYNC in the multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1).
Note 4: RLINK data (Fs bits) is updated one bit prior to even frames and held for two frames.
Figure 35-2. Receive-Side ESF Timing
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
1
2
3
4
5
FRAME#
RSYNC1
RFSYNC
RSYNC2
RSYNC3
RLCLK 4
RLINK5
TLCLK6
TLINK 7
Note 1: RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.4 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.6 = 0).
Note 2: RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.4 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.6 = 1).
Note 3: RSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).
Note 4: ZBTSI mode disabled (T1RCR2.2 = 0).
Note 5: RLINK data (FDL bits) is updated one bit time before odd frames and held for two frames.
Note 6: ZBTSI mode is enabled (T1RCR2.2 = 1).
Note 7: RLINK data (Z bits) is updated one bit time before odd frames and held for four frames.
208 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-3. Receive-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)
RCLK
CHANNEL 23
CHANNEL 24
CHANNEL 1
MSB
LSB
LSB MSB
F
RSER
RSYNC
RFSYNC
CHANNEL 23
CHANNEL 24
C/A
CHANNEL 1
A
C/A
A
B
A
B
D/B
D/B
RSIG
RCHCLK
1
RCHBLK
RLCLK
2
RLINK
Note 1: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24.
Note 2: Shown is RLINK/RLCLK in the ESF framing mode.
Figure 35-4. Receive-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store
Enabled)
RSYSCLK
CHANNEL 23
CHANNEL 24
CHANNEL 1
MSB
LSB
LSB MSB
F
RSER
RSYNC1
RMSYNC
RSYNC2
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 23
C/A
CHANNEL 24
C/A
A
A
B
A
B
D/B
D/B
RSIG
RCHCLK
RCHBLK 3
Note 1: RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).
Note 2: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).
Note 3: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24.
209 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-5. Receive-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store
Enabled)
RSYSCLK
CHANNEL 31
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 1
1
5
LSB
F
LSB MSB
RSER
2
RSYNC
RMSYNC
3
RSYNC
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 32
C/A
CHANNEL 31
C/A
A
B
A
B
D/B
D/B
RSIG
RCHCLK
RCHBLK4
Note 1: RSER data in channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 are forced to 1.
Note 2: RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).
Note 3: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).
Note 4: RCHBLK is forced to 1 in the same channels as RSER (see Note 1).
Note 5: The F-bit position is passed through the receive-side elastic store.
Figure 35-6. Transmit-Side D4 Timing
FRAME#
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12
1
2
3
4
5
TSYNC1
TSSYNC
TSYNC2
TSYNC3
TLCLK
TLINK4
Note 1: TSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.1 = 0).
Note 2: TSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.1 = 1).
Note 3: TSYNC in the multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1).
Note 4: TLINK data (Fs bits) is sampled during the F-bit position of even frames for insertion into the outgoing T1 stream when enabled through
T1TCR1.2.
210 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-7. Transmit-Side ESF Timing
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
1
2
3
4
5
FRAME#
TSYNC1
TSSYNC
TSYNC2
TSYNC3
TLCLK4
TLINK
TLCLK5
TLINK6
Note 1: TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.3 = 0).
Note 2: TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.3 = 1).
Note 3: TSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1).
Note 4: TLINK data (FDL bits) sampled during the F-bit time of odd frame and inserted into the outgoing T1 stream if enabled through TCR1.2.
Note 5: ZBTSI mode is enabled (T1TCR2.1 = 1).
Note 6: TLINK data (Z bits) sampled during the F-bit time of frames 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, and 21 and inserted into the outgoing stream if enabled
through T1TCR1.2.
Figure 35-8. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (with Elastic Store Disabled)
TCLK
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 2
LSB
F
MSB
LSB MSB
LSB MSB
TSER
TSYNC1
TSYNC2
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 2
D/B
A
B
C/A D/B
A
B
C/A D/B
TSIG
TCHCLK
TCHBLK3
TLCLK
DON'T CARE
TLINK4
Note 1: TSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.1 = 1).
Note 2: TSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.1 = 0).
Note 3: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 2.
Note 4: Shown is TLINK/TLCLK in the ESF framing mode.
211 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-9. Transmit-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store
Enabled)
TSYSCLK
CHANNEL 23
CHANNEL 24
CHANNEL 1
LSB MSB
LSB
F
MSB
TSER
TSSYNC
CHANNEL 23
CHANNEL 24
CHANNEL 1
A
A
B
C/A D/B
A
B
C/A D/B
TSIG
TCHCLK
TCHBLK1
Note 1: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24 (if the TPCSI bit is set, then the signaling data at TSIG is ignored during channel 24).
Figure 35-10. Transmit-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store
Enabled)
TSYSCLK
CHANNEL 31
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 1
TSER1
F4
LSB MSB
LSB
TSSYNC
CHANNEL 31
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 1
A
B
C/A D/B
A
B
C/A D/B
A
TSIG
TCHCLK
TCHBLK2,3
Note 1: TSER data in channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 is ignored.
Note 2: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 31 (if the TPCSI bit is set, then the signaling data at TSIG will be ignored).
Note 3: TCHBLK is forced to 1 in the same channels as TSER is ignored (see Note 1).
Note 4: The F-bit position for the T1 frame is sampled and passed through the transmit-side elastic store into the MSB bit position of channel 1.
(Normally, the transmit-side formatter overwrites the F-bit position unless the formatter is programmed to pass through the F-bit
position.)
212 of 238
DS2155
35.2 E1 Mode
Figure 35-11. Receive-Side Timing
1
FRAME#
RFSYNC
RSYNC 1
RSYNC2
RLCLK 3
RLINK 4
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1
Note 1: RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0).
Note 2: RSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1).
Note 3: RLCLK is programmed to output just the Sa bits.
Note 4: RLINK always outputs all five Sa bits as well as the rest of the receive data stream.
Note 5: This diagram assumes the CAS MF begins in the RAF frame.
Figure 35-12. Receive-Side Boundary Timing (with Elastic Store Disabled)
RCLK
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 2
MSB
LSB Si
1
A
Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8
RSER
RSYNC
RFSYNC
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 2
C
D
A
A
B
B
RSIG
RCHCLK
RCHBLK1
RLCLK
Note 4
RLINK 2
Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8
Note 1: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 1.
Note 2: RLCLK is programmed to mark the Sa4 bit in RLINK.
Note 3: Shown is a RNAF frame boundary.
Note 4: RSIG normally contains the CAS multiframe alignment nibble (0000) in channel 1.
213 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-13. Receive-Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (Elastic
Store Enabled)
RSYSCLK
CHANNEL 23/31
LSB MSB
CHANNEL 24/32
CHANNEL 1/2
RSER1
RSYNC2
RMSYNC
RSYNC3
MSB
LSB
F
RCHCLK
RCHBLK 4
Note 1: Data from the E1 channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 is dropped (channel 2 from the E1 link is mapped to channel 1 of the T1 link,
etc.) and the F-bit position is added (forced to on 1).
Note 2: RSYNC in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).
Note 3: RSYNC in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).
Note 4: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24.
Figure 35-14. Receive-Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (Elastic
Store Enabled)
RSYSCLK
CHANNEL 31
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 1
LSB MSB
MSB
LSB
RSER
RSYNC1
RMSYNC
2
RSYNC
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 31
C
C
A
B
A
B
D
D
RSIG
RCHCLK
RCHBLK3
Note 4
Note 1: RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).
Note 2: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).
Note 3: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 1.
Note 4: RSIG normally contains the CAS multiframe alignment nibble (0000) in channel 1.
214 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-15. Receive IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing
FRAMER #1, CHANNEL #1
RSYNC
1
F2 C32
F2 C32
F1 C1
F1 C1
F2 C1
F2 C1
F1 C2
F1 C2
F2 C2
F2 C2
RSER
1
RSIG
2
F3 32
F3 C32
F4 32
F1 C1
F1 C1
F2 C1
F2 C1
F3 C1
F3 C1
F4 C1
F4 C1
F1 C2
F1 C2
F2 C2
F2 C2
F3 C2
F3 C2
F4 C2
F4 C2
RSER
RSIG2
F4 C32
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
3
RSER
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C32
C32 C32 C32
C1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
RSIG3
C32
C32 C32
C32
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
BIT LEVEL DETAIL (4.096MHz bus configurtation)
RSYSCLK
RSYNC4
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
MSB
LSB
LSB
D
LSB MSB
RSER
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
RSIG
Note 1: 4.096MHz bus configuration.
Note 2: 8.192MHz bus configuration.
Note 3: 16.384MHz bus configuration.
Note 4: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).
215 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-16. Receive IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing
FRAMER #1, CHANNELS 1 through 32
RSYNC
1
F2
F2
F1
F1
F2
F2
F1
F1
F2
F2
RSER
1
RSIG
2
F3
F3
F5
F4
F4
F1
F1
F2
F2
F3
F3
F4
F4
F1
F1
F2
F2
F3
F3
F4
F4
RSER
RSIG2
3
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
RSER
RSIG3
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
BIT LEVEL DETAIL (4.096MHz bus configurtation)
RSYSCLK
RSYNC4
FRAMER1, CHANNEL 2
FRAMER1, CHANNEL 2
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
MSB
LSB
LSB
D
LSB MSB
RSER
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
RSIG
Note 1: 4.096MHz bus configuration.
Note 2: 8.192MHz bus configuration.
Note 3: 16.384MHz bus configuration.
Note 4: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).
216 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-17. G.802 Timing, E1 Mode Only
31 32 0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 0
1
2
TS #
RSYNC
TSYNC
RCHCLK
TCHCLK
RCHBLK
TCHBLK
RCLK / RSYSCLK
TCLK / TSYSCLK
CHANNEL 25
CHANNEL 26
MSB
LSB
RSER / TSER
RCHCLK / TCHCLK
RCHBLK / TCHBLK
Note 1: RCHBLK or TCHBLK programmed to pulse high during time slots 1 through 15, 17 through 25, and bit 1 of time slot 26.
Figure 35-18. Transmit-Side Timing
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13
1
14 15 16
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
FRAME# 14 15 16
TSYNC1
TSSYNC
TSYNC2
TLCLK 3
TLINK3
Note 1: TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0).
Note 2: TSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1).
Note 3: TLINK is programmed to source just the Sa4 bit.
Note 4: This diagram assumes both the CAS MF and the CRC4 MF begin with the TAF frame.
Note 5: TLINK and TLCLK are not synchronous with TSSYNC.
217 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-19. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)
TCLK
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 2
LSB
MSB
LSB MSB
Si
1
A
Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8
TSER
TSYNC1
TSYNC2
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 2
D
A
B
C
D
TSIG
TCHCLK
TCHBLK3
TLCLK4
TLINK4
DON'T CARE
DON'T CARE
Note 1: TSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.1 = 1).
Note 2: TSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.1 = 0).
Note 3: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 2.
Note 4: TLINK is programmed to source the Sa4 bit.
Note 5: The signaling data at TSIG during channel 1 is normally overwritten in the transmit formatter with the CAS MF alignment nibble (0000).
Note 6: Shown is a TNAF frame boundary.
Figure 35-20. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz
(Elastic Store Enabled)
TSYSCLK
CHANNEL 23
CHANNEL 24
CHANNEL 1
1
LSB MSB
LSB
F
MSB
TSER
TSSYNC
TCHCLK
TCHBLK2
Note 1: The F-bit position in the TSER data is ignored.
Note 2: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24.
218 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-21. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (Elastic
Store Enabled)
TSYSCLK
CHANNEL 31
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 1
CHANNEL 1
TSER1
F4
LSB MSB
LSB
D
TSSYNC
CHANNEL 31
CHANNEL 32
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
TSIG
TCHCLK
TCHBLK2,3
Note 1: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 31.
219 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-22. Transmit IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing
FRAMER #1, CHANNEL #1
TSSYNC
1
F2 C32
F2 C32
F1 C1
F1 C1
F2 C1
F2 C1
F1 C2
F1 C2
F2 C2
F2 C2
TSER
TRSIG 1
TSER2
TSIG2
F3 32
F3 C32
F4 32
F1 C1
F1 C1
F2 C1
F2 C1
F3 C1
F3 C1
F4 C1
F4 C1
F1 C2
F1 C2
F2 C2
F2 C2
F3 C2
F3 C2
F4 C2
F4 C2
F4 C32
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
TSER3
TSIG3
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C32
C32 C32 C32
C1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
C32
C32 C32
C32
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
BIT LEVEL DETAIL (4.096MHz bus configurtation)
TSYSCLK
TSYNC4
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
MSB
LSB
LSB
D
LSB MSB
TSER
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
TSIG
Note 1: 4.096MHz bus configuration.
Note 2: 8.192MHz bus configuration.
Note 3: 16.384MHz bus configuration.
Note 4: TSYNC is in input mode.
220 of 238
DS2155
Figure 35-23. Transmit IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing
FRAMER #1, CHANNELS 1 through 32
TSSYNC
1
F2
F2
F1
F1
F2
F2
F1
F1
F2
F2
TSER
1
TSIG
TSER2
TSIG2
TSER3
TSIG3
F3
F3
F5
F4
F4
F1
F1
F2
F2
F3
F3
F4
F4
F1
F1
F2
F2
F3
F3
F4
F4
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
BIT LEVEL DETAIL (4.096MHz bus configurtation)
TSYSCLK
TSYNC4
FRAMER1, CHANNEL 2
FRAMER1, CHANNEL 2
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
MSB
LSB
LSB
D
LSB MSB
TSER
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
TSIG
Note 1: 4.096MHz bus configuration.
Note 2: 8.192MHz bus configuration.
Note 3: 16.384MHz bus configuration.
Note 4: TSYNC is in input mode.
221 of 238
DS2155
36. OPERATING PARAMETERS
ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS
Voltage Range on Any Pin Relative to Ground
Operating Temperature Range for DS2155L
Operating Temperature Range for DS2155LN
Storage Temperature Range
-1.0V to +6.0V
0°C to +70°C
-40°C to +85°C (Note 1)
-55°C to +125°C
Soldering Temperature
See IPC/JEDEC J-STD-020
This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operation
sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods of time may affect reliability.
Note 1: Specifications to -40°C are guaranteed by design and not production tested.
THERMAL CHARACTERISTICS
PARAMETER
Ambient Temperature
Junction Temperature
CONDITIONS
MIN
TYP
MAX
+85°C
+125°C
(Note 2)
-40°C
Theta-JA (θJA) in Still Air for
100-Pin LQFP
Theta-JA (θJA) in Still Air for
10mm CSBGA
(Note 3)
(Note 3)
+32°C/W
+40°C/W
THETA-JA (θJA) vs. AIRFLOW
FORCED AIR
(meters per second)
THETA-JA (θJA)
100-PIN LQFP
+32°C/W
THETA-JA (θJA)
10mm CSBGA
40°C/W
0
1
+27°C/W
34°C/W
2.5
+24°C/W
30°C/W
RECOMMENDED DC OPERATING CONDITIONS
(TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)
PARAMETER
Logic 1
Logic 0
Supply
SYMBOL
CONDITIONS
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
VIH
VIL
VDD
2.0
-0.3
3.135
5.5
+0.8
3.465
V
V
V
(Note 4)
3.3
CAPACITANCE
(TA = +25°C)
PARAMETER
Input Capacitance
SYMBOL
CIN
CONDITIONS
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
pF
5
7
Output Capacitance
COUT
pF
222 of 238
DS2155
DC CHARACTERISTICS
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)
PARAMETER
Supply Current
Input Leakage
Output Leakage
Output Current (2.4V)
Output Current (0.4V)
SYMBOL
CONDITIONS
(Note 5)
(Note 6)
(Note 7)
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
IDD
IIL
ILO
IOH
IOL
75
mA
μA
μA
mA
mA
-1.0
+1.0
1.0
-1.0
+4.0
Note 2: The package is mounted on a four-layer JEDEC standard test board.
Note 3: Theta-JA (θJA) is the junction to ambient thermal resistance, when the package is mounted on a four-layer JEDEC standard test board.
Note 4: Applies to RVDD, TVDD, and DVDD
.
Note 5: TCLK = TCLKI = RCLKI = TSYSCLK = RSYSCLK = MCLK = 1.544MHz; outputs open-circuited.
Note 6: 0.0V < VIN < VDD
Note 7: Applied to INT when tri-stated.
223 of 238
DS2155
37. AC TIMING PARAMETERS AND DIAGRAMS
Capacitive test loads are 40pF for bus signals, 20pF for all others.
37.1Multiplexed Bus AC Characteristics
AC CHARACTERISTICS: MULTIPLEXED PARALLEL PORT (MUX = 1)
(Figure 37-1, Figure 37-2, and Figure 37-3)
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)
PARAMETER
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN
TYP MAX UNITS
Cycle Time
tCYC
PWEL
PWEH
tR, tF
tRWH
200
100
100
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Pulse Width, DS Low or RD High
Pulse Width, DS High or RD Low
Input Rise/Fall Times
R/W Hold Time
R/W Setup Time Before DS High
20
50
10
50
tRWS
CS Setup Time Before DS, WR, or RD
tCS
20
ns
Active
tCH
tDHR
tDHW
tASL
tAHL
0
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
CS Hold Time
Read Data Hold Time
Write Data Hold Time
Muxed Address Valid to AS or ALE Fall
10
0
15
10
Muxed Address Hold Time
Delay Time DS, WR, or RD to AS or ALE
tASD
20
ns
Rise
Pulse Width AS or ALE High
Delay Time, AS or ALE to DS, WR or RD
Output Data Delay Time from DS or RD
PWASH
tASED
tDDR
30
10
20
ns
ns
ns
80
Data Setup Time
tDSW
50
ns
224 of 238
DS2155
Figure 37-1. Intel Multiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 1)
t
CYC
ALE
PW
ASH
t
ASD
WR*
RD*
t
ASED
t
ASD
PW
EH
t
t
CH
PW
CS
EL
CS*
t
t
ASL
t
DHR
DDR
AD0-AD7
t
AHL
Figure 37-2. Intel Multiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 1)
t
CYC
ALE
PW
ASH
t
ASD
RD*
WR*
t
t
ASED
ASD
PW
EH
t
t
CH
PW
EL
CS
CS*
t
t
ASL
DHW
AD0-AD7
t
t
AHL
DSW
225 of 238
DS2155
Figure 37-3. Motorola Multiplexed Bus Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 1)
PW
ASH
AS
PW
EH
t
t
ASED
ASD
DS
PW
EL
t
CYC
t
t
RWS
RWH
R/W*
t
t
DDR
t
ASL
DHR
AD0-AD7
(read)
t
t
AHL
t
CH
CS
CS*
t
DSW
t
ASL
t
AD0-AD7
(write)
t
DHW
AHL
226 of 238
DS2155
37.2Nonmultiplexed Bus AC Characteristics
AC CHARACTERISTICS: NONMULTIPLEXED PARALLEL PORT (MUX = 0)
(Figure 37-4, Figure 37-5, Figure 37-6, and Figure 37-7)
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C; for DS2155LN.)
PARAMETER
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN
TYP MAX UNITS
Setup Time for A0 to A7, Valid to CS
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
0
0
ns
Active
Setup Time for CS Active to Either RD,
WR, or DS Active
ns
Delay Time from Either RD or DS Active
75
20
ns
ns
ns
to Data Valid
Hold Time from Either RD, WR, or DS
Inactive to CS Inactive
0
5
Hold Time from CS Inactive to Data Bus
Tri-State
Wait Time from Either WR or DS Active
t6
t7
t8
t9
75
10
10
10
ns
ns
ns
ns
to Latch Data
Data Setup Time to Either WR or DS
Inactive
Data Hold Time from Either WR or DS
Inactive
Address Hold from Either WR or DS
Inactive
227 of 238
DS2155
Figure 37-4. Intel Nonmultiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 0)
ADDRESS VALID
A0 to A7
DATA VALID
D0 to D7
t5
5ns (min) / 20ns (max)
WR
CS
RD
t1
0ns (min)
t2
0ns (min)
t3
t4
0ns (min)
50ns (max)
Figure 37-5. Intel Nonmultiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 0)
ADDRESS VALID
A0 to A7
D0 to D7
t7
t8
10ns (min)
10ns (min)
RD
CS
t1
0ns (min)
t2
t6
75ns (min)
t4
0ns (min)
0ns (min)
WR
228 of 238
DS2155
Figure 37-6. Motorola Nonmultiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 0)
ADDRESS VALID
A0 to A7
D0 to D7
R/W
DATA VALID
5ns (min) / 20ns (max)
t5
t1
0ns (min)
t2
CS
t3
t4
0ns (min)
0ns (min)
75ns (max)
DS
Figure 37-7. Motorola Nonmultiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 0)
ADDRESS VALID
A0 to A7
D0 to D7
10ns (min)
10ns (min)
0ns (min)
t8
t7
R/W
CS
t1
0ns (min)
t2
t6
75ns (min)
t4
0ns (min)
DS
229 of 238
DS2155
37.3Receive-Side AC Characteristics
AC CHARACTERISTICS: RECEIVE SIDE
(Figure 37-8., Figure 37-9, and Figure 37-10)
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)
PARAMETER
RCLKO Period
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN
TYP
488 (E1)
648 (T1)
MAX UNITS
tLP
ns
tLH
(Note 1)
200
0.5 tLP
0.5 tLP
0.5 tLP
RCLKO Pulse Width
RCLKO Pulse Width
ns
ns
tLL
tLH
tLL
200
150
150
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
(Note 2)
0.5 tLP
488 (E1)
648 (T1)
0.5 tCP
RCLKI Period
tCP
ns
ns
tCH
tCL
20
20
RCLKI Pulse Width
0.5 tCP
(Note 3)
(Note 4)
(Note 5)
(Note 6)
(Note 7)
648
488
244
122
61
ns
ns
RSYSCLK Period
tSP
tSH
tSL
20
20
0.5 tSP
0.5 tSP
ns
ns
RSYSCLK Pulse Width
RSYNC Setup to RSYSCLK Falling
RSYNC Pulse Width
RPOSI/RNEGI Setup to RCLKI Falling
tSU
tPW
tSU
20
50
20
ns
ns
ns
RPOSI/RNEGI Hold From RCLKI
tHD
20
ns
Falling
RSYSCLK, RCLKI Rise and Fall Times
tR, tF
tDD
22
50
ns
ns
Delay RCLKO to RPOSO, RNEGO Valid
Delay RCLK to RSER, RDATA, RSIG,
RLINK Valid
tD1
50
ns
Delay RCLK to RCHCLK, RSYNC,
tD2
tD3
tD4
50
22
22
ns
ns
ns
RCHBLK, RFSYNC, RLCLK
Delay RSYSCLK to RSER, RSIG Valid
Delay RSYSCLK to RCHCLK,
RCHBLK, RMSYNC, RSYNC
Note 1: Jitter attenuator enabled in the receive path.
Note 2: Jitter attenuator disabled or enabled in the transmit path.
Note 3: RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz
Note 4: RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz
Note 5: RSYSCLK = 4.096MHz
Note 6: RSYSCLK = 8.192MHz
Note 7: RSYSCLK = 16.384MHz
230 of 238
DS2155
Figure 37-8. Receive-Side Timing
RCLK
t
D1
1ST FRAME BIT
RSER / RDATA / RSIG
t
t
D2
D2
1
RSYNC
RFSYNC / RMSYNC
RCHCLK
t
D2
t
t
D2
D2
RCHBLK
2
RLCLK
t
D1
RLINK (T1MODE)
Sa4 to Sa8
Bit Position
4
RLINK (E1 MODE)
Note 1: RSYNC is in the output mode.
Note 2: Shown is RLINK/RLCLK in the ESF framing mode.
Note 3: No relationship between RCHCLK and RCHBLK and other signals is implied.
Note 4: RLCLK only pulses high during Sa bit locations as defined in the E1RCR2 register.
231 of 238
DS2155
Figure 37-9. Receive-Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled
t
t
SL
SH
t
t
F
R
RSYSCLK
t
SP
t
D3
SEE NOTE 3
RSER / RSIG
t
D4
RCHCLK
RCHBLK
RMSYNC
t
D4
t
t
D4
D4
1
RSYNC
t
HD
t
SU
2
RSYNC
Note 1: RSYNC is in the output mode.
Note 2: RSYNC is in the input mode.
Note 3: F-bit when MSTRREG.1 = 0, MSB of TS0 when MSTREG.1 = 1.
Figure 37-10. Receive Line Interface Timing
t
t
LL
LH
RCLKO
t
t
LP
DD
RPOSO, RNEGO
t
t
CL
CH
t
t
F
R
RCLKI
t
t
CP
SU
RPOSI, RNEGI
t
HD
232 of 238
DS2155
37.4Backplane Clock Timing: AC Characteristics
AC CHARACTERISTICS: BACKPLANE CLOCK SYNTHESIS
(Figure 37-11)
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)
PARAMETER
Delay RCLK to BPCLK
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN
TYP
MAX UNITS
10 ns
tD1
Figure 37-11 Receive Timing Delay RCLK to BPCLK
RCLK
t
D1
BPCLK
Note 1: If RCLK is 1.544 MHz, BPCLK will be asynchronous.
233 of 238
DS2155
37.5Transmit AC Characteristics
AC CHARACTERISTICS: TRANSMIT SIDE
(Figure 37-12, Figure 37-13, and Figure 37-14)
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155LN)
PARAMETER
TCLK Period
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN TYP (E1) MAX UNITS
488 (E1)
tCP
ns
ns
ns
ns
648 (T1)
0.5 tCP
0.5 tCP
488 (E1)
648 (T1)
0.5 tLP
0.5 tLP
648
tCH
tCL
20
20
TCLK Pulse Width
TCLKI Period
tLP
tLH
tLL
20
20
TCLKI Pulse Width
(Note 8)
(Note 9)
(Note 10)
(Note 11)
(Note 12)
448
244
TSYSCLK Period
tSP
ns
122
61
20
20
0.5 tSP
TSYSCLK Pulse Width
tSP
ns
0.5 tSP
TSYNC or TSSYNC Setup to TCLK or
TSYSCLK Falling
TSYNC or TSSYNC Pulse Width
tSU
20
50
ns
ns
tPW
TSER, TSIG, TDATA, TLINK, TPOSI,
TNEGI Setup to TCLK, TSYSCLK,
TCLKI Falling
tSU
20
ns
TSER, TSIG, TDATA, TLINK Hold
from TCLK or TSYSCLK Falling
TPOSI, TNEGI Hold from TCLKI
Falling
tHD
tHD
tR, tF
tDD
tD1
20
20
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
TCLK, TCLKI or TSYSCLK Rise and
Fall Times
25
50
50
50
22
Delay TCLKO to TPOSO, TNEGO
Valid
Delay TCLK to TESO, UT-UTDO
Valid
Delay TCLK to TCHBLK, TCHCLK,
TSYNC, TLCLK
tD2
Delay TSYSCLK to TCHCLK,
TCHBLK
tD3
Note 8: TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz
Note 9: TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz
Note 10: TSYSCLK = 4.096MHz
Note 11: TSYSCLK = 8.192MHz
Note 12: TSYSCLK = 16.384MHz
234 of 238
DS2155
Figure 37-12. Transmit-Side Timing
t
CP
t
t
CL
CH
t
t
F
R
TCLK
TESO
t
D1
t
SU
TSER / TSIG /
TDATA
t
t
HD
D2
TCHCLK
TCHBLK
t
D2
t
D2
1
TSYNC
t
HD
t
SU
2
TSYNC
t
D2
5
TLCLK
t
HD
TLINK
t
SU
Note 1: TSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.1 = 1).
Note 2: TSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.1 = 0).
Note 3: TSER is sampled on the falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled.
Note 4: TCHCLK and TCHBLK are synchronous with TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled.
Note 5: In E1 mode, TLINK is only sampled during Sa bit locations as defined in E1TCR2; no relationship between TLCLK/TLINK and TSYNC
is implied.
235 of 238
DS2155
Figure 37-13. Transmit-Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled
t
SP
t
t
SL
SH
t
t
F
R
TSYSCLK
TSER
t
SU
t
t
D3
HD
TCHCLK
TCHBLK
t
D3
t
HD
t
SU
TSSYNC
Note 1: TSER is only sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.
Note 2: TCHCLK and TCHBLK are synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.
Figure 37-14. Transmit Line Interface Timing
TCLKO
TPOSO, TNEGO
t
DD
t
LP
t
t
LL
LH
t
t
F
R
TCLKI
t
SU
TPOSI, TNEGI
t
HD
236 of 238
DS2155
38. PACKAGE INFORMATION
(The package drawing(s) in this data sheet may not reflect the most current specifications. The package number provided for
each package is a link to the latest package outline information.)
38.1 100-Pin LQFP (56-G5002-000)
237 of 238
DS2155
38.2 100-Ball CSBGA (56-G6008-001)
238 of 238
Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor cannot assume responsibility for use of any circuitry other than circuitry entirely embodied in a Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor product.
No circuit patent licenses are implied. Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor reserves the right to change the circuitry and specifications without notice at any time.
Maxim Integrated Products, 120 San Gabriel Drive, Sunnyvale, CA 94086 408-737-7600
© 2007 Maxim Integrated Products
The Maxim logo is a registered trademark of Maxim Integrated Products, Inc. The Dallas logo is a registered trademark of Dallas Semiconductor.
相关型号:
SI9130DB
5- and 3.3-V Step-Down Synchronous ConvertersWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9135LG-T1
SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply ControllerWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9135LG-T1-E3
SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply ControllerWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9135_11
SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply ControllerWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9136_11
Multi-Output Power-Supply ControllerWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9130CG-T1-E3
Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9130LG-T1-E3
Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9130_11
Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9137
Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile ApplicationsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9137DB
Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile ApplicationsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9137LG
Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile ApplicationsWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
SI9122E
500-kHz Half-Bridge DC/DC Controller with Integrated Secondary Synchronous Rectification DriversWarning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明